blob: ee3dfcf103a5d0c0bcfd7c52267949a9a0a60a6d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet62cb9992023-06-09 15:10:05 +02006 2023/06/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhus1da7ab32023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001092 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001093 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001094 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001095 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001096 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001097 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001099 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001103 - tune.maxaccept
1104 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001106 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001107 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001108 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1109 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001110 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1111 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001112 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001113 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001114 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001115 - tune.sndbuf.client
1116 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001117 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001118 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1119 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1120 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001121 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001125 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001126 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1129 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1131 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001135 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139------------------------------------
1140
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114151degrees-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
114851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1149 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1150 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1151 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1155
115651degrees-property-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1158 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1161 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1162
116351degrees-cache-size <number>
1164 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1165 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1166 By default, this cache is disabled.
1167
1168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1170
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171ca-base <dir>
1172 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001173 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1174 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1175 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177chroot <jail dir>
1178 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1179 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1180 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1181 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1182 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001184
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1186 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1187 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1188 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1189 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1190 set. These sets have the format
1191
1192 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1193
1194 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001195 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1197 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001198 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1199 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001200 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1201 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1202 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1203 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1204 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1205 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1206 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1207 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1208 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1209 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1212 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1213 on the machine's word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1217 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1218 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1219 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1220 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1221 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001222
1223 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001224 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1225
1226 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1227 # first 4 CPUs
1228
1229 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1230 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1231 # word size.
1232
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001233 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001234 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1237 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1238
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001239 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1240 # and so on.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1243 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001245 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001246 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1247 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1248 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1249
1250 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1251 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1252 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1253
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001254 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1255 # and a thread range.
1256 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1258 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1259
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260crt-base <dir>
1261 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001262 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1263 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265daemon
1266 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1267 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001268 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1269 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001271default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001272 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001273 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1274 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1275 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1276 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1277 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1278 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1279 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1280 not start with a slash ('/'):
1281 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1282 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1283
1284 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1286 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1287 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1288 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1289 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1290 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1291 each of them.
1292
1293 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1294 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1295 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1296 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1297 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1298 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1299 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1300 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1301
1302 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1303 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1306 made easily relocatable.
1307
1308 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1309 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1310 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1311 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1312 consistent across all configuration files.
1313
1314 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1315 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1316 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1317 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1318 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1319 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1320 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1321 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1322
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323description <text>
1324 Add a text that describes the instance.
1325
1326 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1327 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1328 "<" and ">" characters.
1329
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001330deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1331 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001333
1334deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001335 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001336 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1337
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001338deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001339 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1340 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1341 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001342
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001347expose-experimental-directives
1348 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1349 the config file will be rejected.
1350
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001351external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001352 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1353 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001354 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1355 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1356 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1357 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1358 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001359
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001361 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1363 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001364 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001365 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001366 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001367
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001368group <group name>
1369 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1370 See also "gid" and "user".
1371
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001372h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1373 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1374 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1375 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1376 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001377 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001378 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1379 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1380 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1381 specified in a proxy.
1382
1383 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1384 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1385 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1386 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1387 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1388 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1389 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1390
1391 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1392 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1393 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1394 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1395 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1396
1397 Example:
1398 global
1399 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1400
1401 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1402 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1403
1404h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1405 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1406 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1407 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1408 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1409 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1410 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1411 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1412 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1413
1414 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1415 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1416 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001421h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1422 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1423 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1424 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1425 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1426 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1427 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1428 the keyword with "no'.
1429
1430hard-stop-after <time>
1431 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1432
1433 Arguments :
1434 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1435 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1436 SIGUSR1 signal.
1437
1438 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1439 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1440 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1441
1442 Example:
1443 global
1444 hard-stop-after 30s
1445
1446 See also: grace
1447
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001449 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001450 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1451 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1452 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1453 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1454 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1455 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1456 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001458 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1459 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1460 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1461 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1462 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1463 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1464 disable it.
1465
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001466insecure-setuid-wanted
1467 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1468 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1469 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1470 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001472 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001474 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1475 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1478 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1479 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1480 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1481
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001482issuers-chain-path <dir>
1483 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1484 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1485 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001486 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001487 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1488 "issuers-chain-path".
1489 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1490 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1491 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1492 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1493 will share the chain in memory.
1494
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001495localpeer <name>
1496 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1497 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1498 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1499 the configuration parsing.
1500
1501 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1502 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1503
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001504log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001505 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001506 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001508 configured with "log global".
1509
1510 <address> can be one of:
1511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1514 port).
1515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1518 port).
1519
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001520 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001524
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001525 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1526 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1527 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1528 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1529 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1530 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1531 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1532 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1533 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1534 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001535 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001536 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1537 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1538 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1540 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001541
1542 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1543 "fd@2", see above.
1544
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001545 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1546 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1547 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1548 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1549 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1550
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001551 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1552 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001553
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001554 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1555 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1556 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1557 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1558 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1559 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1560 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1561 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1562 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1563 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001564 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1565 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1568 one of the following :
1569
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001570 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1571 field is stripped. This is the default.
1572 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1573 rfc3164.
1574
1575 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001576 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1577
1578 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1579 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1580
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001581 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1582 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1583 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1584 designed to be used with a local log server.
1585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1590 logger consumes.
1591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001592 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1593 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1594 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1595 used with a local log server.
1596
1597 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1598 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1599 designed to be used with a local log server.
1600
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001601 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1602 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1603 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1604 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1605
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001606 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1607 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1608 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1609 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1610 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1611
1612 <sample_size>
1613 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1614 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1615 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1616 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1617 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1618
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001619 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001621 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1622 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1623 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1624
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001625 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1626 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1627 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1628 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629
1630 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001631 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1632 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1633 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1634 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1635 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1636 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001638 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001640log-send-hostname [<string>]
1641 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1642 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1643 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1644 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1645 the logs.
1646
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001647log-tag <string>
1648 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1649 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1650 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001651 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001652
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001653lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1655 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1656 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1657 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1658 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1659 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660 used multiple times.
1661
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001662lua-load-per-thread <file>
1663 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1664 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1665 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1666 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1667 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1668 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1669 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1670 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1671 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1672 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1673 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1674 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1675 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1676 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1677 times.
1678
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001679lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1680 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1681 variable.
1682 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1683 to "path".
1684
1685 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1686 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1687 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1688 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1689 will be checked earlier.
1690
1691 As an example by specifying the following path:
1692
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1694 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1695
1696 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1698 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1699 paths if that does not exist either.
1700
1701 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1702 documentation.
1703
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001704master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001705 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1706 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1707 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1710 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001711 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1712 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1713 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1714 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1715 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001716
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001717 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001719mworker-max-reloads <number>
1720 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001721 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001722 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1723 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1724 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1725
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001726nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1728 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1729 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001730 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1731 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1733 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1734 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001736nbthread <number>
1737 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001738 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001739 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1740 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1741 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1742 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001743 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1744 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1745 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1746 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1747 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1748 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1749 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001750
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001751numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001753 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1754 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1755 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1756 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1757 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1758 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1759 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1760 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001763 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1764 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1765 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1766 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001768pp2-never-send-local
1769 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1770 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1771 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1772 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1773 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1774 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1775 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1776 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1777 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1778 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1779 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1780
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001781presetenv <name> <value>
1782 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1783 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1784 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1785 and "unsetenv".
1786
1787resetenv [<name> ...]
1788 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1789 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1790 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1791 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1792 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1793 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1794 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1795 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001797stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001798 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1799 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1800 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1801 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1802 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1803 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001804 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001805 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1806 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1807 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1808 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001809
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001810server-state-base <directory>
1811 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001812 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1813 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001814
1815server-state-file <file>
1816 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1817 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1818 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1819 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1820 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1821 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1822 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1823 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001824 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1825 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001826
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001827set-dumpable
1828 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1829 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1830 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1831 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1832 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1833 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1834 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1835 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1836 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1837 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1838 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1839 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1840 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1841 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1842 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1843 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1844 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1845 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1846
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001847set-var <var-name> <expr>
1848 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1849 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1850 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1851 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1852 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1853 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1854 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1855 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1856 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1857
1858 Example:
1859 global
1860 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1861 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1862 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1863
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001864setenv <name> <value>
1865 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1866 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1867 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1868 and "unsetenv".
1869
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001875 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1876 information and recommendations see e.g.
1877 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1878 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1879 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001881
1882ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1884 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1885 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1886 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1887 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001888 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1889 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1890 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001891 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001892
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001893ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1895 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1896 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1897 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1898 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1899
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001900ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1902 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1903 keyword to see available options.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001907 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001908
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1911 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001912 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001913 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001914 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1915 information and recommendations see e.g.
1916 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1917 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1918 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1919 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1920 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001921
1922ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1925 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1926 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1927 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001928 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1929 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1930 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1931 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001932
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001933ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1935 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1936 keyword to see available options.
1937
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001938ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1940 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1941 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001943 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001944 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1945 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1946 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1947 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001948 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1949 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1950 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1951
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001952ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1953 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1954 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001955 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001956 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001957 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1958
1959 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001960
1961 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1962 and won't try to remove them.
1963
1964 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1965
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001966ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001968 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1969 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1970 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001971
1972 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1973 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1974 optimize the startup time.
1975
1976 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1977 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1978 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1979
1980 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001981 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
1983 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001984 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1985 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001986
1987 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1988 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1989 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1990 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1991 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001992 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993
1994 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001995 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001996 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1997 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1998 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1999 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2000 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002002
2003 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002005 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002006 a cert bundle.
2007
2008 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2009 separately in several "crt".
2010
2011 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2012 since files are loading separately.
2013
2014 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2015 required to commit them.
2016
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002017 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002018 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002019
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002020 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2021 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2022 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002024 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2025 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2026 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002027
2028 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002029 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2030 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002031
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002032 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2033 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2034
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002035 The default behavior is "all".
2036
2037 Example:
2038 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2039 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2040 ssl-load-extra-files none
2041
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002042 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2043 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002044
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002045ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2046 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2047 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2048 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2049
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002050ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002051 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002052 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2053 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2054 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2055 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2056 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2057 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002058 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002059
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002060stats maxconn <connections>
2061 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2062 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2065 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2066 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2067 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002068 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002069 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002070
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002071 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2072 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2073 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002074
2075stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2076 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2077 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002078 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002079
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002080strict-limits
2081 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2082 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2083 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2084 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2085 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002087uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002088 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2090 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2091 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2092
2093ulimit-n <number>
2094 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2095 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2096 option.
2097
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002098unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2099 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2100
2101 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2102 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2103 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2104 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2105 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002107 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2108 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2109 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2110 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2111
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002112unsetenv [<name> ...]
2113 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2114 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2115 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2116 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2117 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2118 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2119 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002121user <user name>
2122 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2123 See also "uid" and "group".
2124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002125node <name>
2126 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2127
2128 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2129 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2130 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2131 traffic.
2132
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002133wurfl-cache-size <size>
2134 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2135 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2136 - "0" : no cache is used.
2137 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002139 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2140 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002141
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142wurfl-data-file <file path>
2143 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2144 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
2149wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2150 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2151 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2152 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2153
2154 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2155
2156 Valid WURFL properties are:
2157 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2158
2159 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2160 device.
2161
2162 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2163 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2164
2165 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2166 particular web request.
2167
2168 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2169 used Libwurfl API version.
2170
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2172 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2173
2174 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2175 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2176
2177 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002179 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180 with USE_WURFL=1.
2181
2182wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2183 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2184 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2185
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002186 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002187 with USE_WURFL=1.
2188
2189wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2190 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2191 thus before the chroot.
2192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002193 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002194 with USE_WURFL=1.
2195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021963.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197-----------------------
2198
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002199busy-polling
2200 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2201 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2202 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2203 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2204 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2205 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2206 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2207 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2208 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2209 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2210 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2211 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2212 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2213 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2214 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2215 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2216 "poll" pollers.
2217
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002218 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2219 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2220 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2221
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002222max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002223 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002224 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2225 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2226 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2227 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2228 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2229 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2230 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2231
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002232maxcompcpuusage <number>
2233 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2234 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2235 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2236 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2237 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2238 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2239 and from introducing high latencies.
2240
2241maxcomprate <number>
2242 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2243 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2244 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2245 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2246 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2247 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2248 default value.
2249
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250maxconn <number>
2251 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2252 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2253 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002254 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2255 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2256 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2257 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002258 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2259 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2260 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2261 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2262 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2263 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002264
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002265maxconnrate <number>
2266 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2267 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2268 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2269 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2270 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2271 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2272 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2273 fairness.
2274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002275maxpipes <number>
2276 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2277 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2278 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2279 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2280 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2281 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2282
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002283maxsessrate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2285 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2286 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2287 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2288 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2289 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2290 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2291 fairness.
2292
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002293maxsslconn <number>
2294 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2295 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2296 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2297 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2298 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2299 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2300 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002301 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2302 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2303 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2304 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002305 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002306 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2307 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002308
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002309maxsslrate <number>
2310 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2311 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2312 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2313 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2314 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2315 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2316 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2317 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2318 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2319 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2320
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002321maxzlibmem <number>
2322 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2323 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2324 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002325 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2326 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2327 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2328
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002329no-memory-trimming
2330 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2331 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2332 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2333 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2334 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2335 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2336 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2337 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2338 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2339 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2340 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2341 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2342 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2343 not suffer from such a problem.
2344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345noepoll
2346 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002349
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002350noevports
2351 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2352 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2353 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2354 also "nopoll".
2355
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002356nogetaddrinfo
2357 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2358 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2359
2360nokqueue
2361 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2362 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2363 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002365nopoll
2366 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2367 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002369 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2370 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002371
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372noreuseport
2373 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2374 command line argument "-dR".
2375
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002376nosplice
2377 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002379 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002380 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002381 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2382 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2383 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2384 "option splice-response".
2385
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002386profiling.memory { on | off }
2387 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2388 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2389 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2390 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2391 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2392 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2393 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2394 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2395 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2396
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002397profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2399 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2400 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2401 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002403 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2404 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2405 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2406 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2407
2408 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2409 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2410 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2411 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2412 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002413 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2414 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2415 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2416 CLI.
2417
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002418spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002419 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2420 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2421 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2422 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2423 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2424 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002426ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002427 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002428 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002429 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002430 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002431 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2432 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2433 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002434 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2435 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002436 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2437 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2438 openssl configuration file uses:
2439 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2440
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002441ssl-mode-async
2442 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002443 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002444 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2445 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002446 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002447 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002448 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002449
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002450tune.buffers.limit <number>
2451 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2452 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2453 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2454 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2455 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002457 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2458 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2459 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2460 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2461 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2462 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2463 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2464 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002465 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002466
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002467tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2468 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2469 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2470 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002471 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002472
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002473tune.bufsize <number>
2474 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2475 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2476 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2477 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2478 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2479 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2480 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002481 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2482 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002484 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002485 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002486 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2487 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002488
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002489tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2490 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002491
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002492tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2493 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2494 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2495 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2496 this value. The default value is 1.
2497
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002498tune.fail-alloc
2499 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2500 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2501 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2502 gracefully.
2503
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002504tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2506 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2507 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2508 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2509 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2510
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002511tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2512 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2513 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2514 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2515 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2516 change it.
2517
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002518tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2519 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002521 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002522 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2523 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2524 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2525 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2526 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2527
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002528tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2529 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2530 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2531 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2532 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2533 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002534 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002535 recommended not to change this value.
2536
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002537tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002538 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002539 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002540 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002541 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2542 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2543 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2544 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2545
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546tune.http.cookielen <number>
2547 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2548 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2549 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2550 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2551 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2552 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2553 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2554 to change this value.
2555
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002556tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002557 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2558 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002559 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002560 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002561 configuration directives too.
2562 The default value is 1024.
2563
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002564tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2565 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2566 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2567 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2568 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2569 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2570 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002571 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2572 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2573 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002574
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002575tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2577 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2578 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2579 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2580 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2581 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002582 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2583 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2584 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2585 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2586 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002587
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002588tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002589 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002590 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2591 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2592 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2593 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002594 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002596 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002597 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2598
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002599tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2600 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2601 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2602 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2603 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2604 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2605 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2606 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2607 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2608 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2609
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002610tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2611 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002612 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002613 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2614 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002615 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002616 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2617 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2618
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002619tune.lua.maxmem
2620 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2621 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2622 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2623 memory.
2624
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002625tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2626 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002627 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2628 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002630
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002631tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2632 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2633 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2634 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002635 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002636
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002637tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2638 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2639 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2640 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2641 check servers.
2642
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002643tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002644 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2645 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002646 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2647 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2648 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2649 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2650 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2651 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2652 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2653 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2654 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002655
2656tune.maxpollevents <number>
2657 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2658 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2659 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2660 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2661 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2662
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002663tune.maxrewrite <number>
2664 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2665 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2666 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2667 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2668 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2669 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2670 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2671 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2672 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2673 bufsize.
2674
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002675tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2676 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2677 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2678 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2679 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2680 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2681 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2682 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2683 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2684 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002685 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2686 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002687 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2688 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2689 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2690 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2691 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2692 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2693 setting this parameter to 0.
2694
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002695tune.pipesize <number>
2696 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2697 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2698 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2699 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2700 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2701 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2702
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002703tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2704 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002705 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002706 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2707 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2708 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2709 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002710 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002711
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002712tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2713 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002714 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002715 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2716 default is 20.
2717
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002718tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2719tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2720 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2721 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2722 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002723 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002724 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002725 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2726 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2727
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002728tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002729 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002730 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2731 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2732 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2733 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2734
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002735tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002736 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002737 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2738 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2739 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2740 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2741 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2742 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2743 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002744
2745tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002747 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002748 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2749 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2750 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2751 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2752 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2753 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2754 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002755
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002756tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2757tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2758 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2759 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2760 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002761 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002762 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002763 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2764 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2765 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2766 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002767 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002768
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002769tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002770 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002771 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2772 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2773 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2774 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2775 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2776 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2777 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2778 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2779 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2780 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2781 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002782
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002783tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2784 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2785 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2786 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2787 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2788
2789tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2790 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2791 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2792 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2793 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2794 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2795 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2796 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2797 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2798 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2799 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2800 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2801 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2802
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002803tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002804 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002805 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2806 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2807 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2808 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2809 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2810
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002811tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2812 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2813 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2814 performances. This is disabled by default.
2815
2816 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2817 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2818
2819 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2820
2821 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2822
2823 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2824
2825 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2826 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2827 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2828
2829 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2830 converted.
2831
2832 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2833 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2834 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2835 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2836 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2837 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2838 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002839 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2840 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002841
2842 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2843
2844 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2845 only need this line:
2846
2847 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2848
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002849tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2850 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002851 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002852 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2853 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2854 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2855 being used for too long.
2856
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002857tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2858 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2859 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2860 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2861 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2862 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2863 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2864 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2865 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2866 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2867 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002868 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002869 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2875 1000 entries.
2876
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002877tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002878tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002879tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2880tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2881tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002882 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2883 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2884 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2885 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2886 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2887 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2888 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2889 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002890
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002891 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2892 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2893 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2894 all available space is consumed.
2895 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2896 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2897 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002898
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002899tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2900 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002901 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002902 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002903 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002904 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2905
2906tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2907 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2908 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2910 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029123.3. Debugging
2913--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002915quiet
2916 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2917 line argument "-q".
2918
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002919zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002921 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2922 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2923 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2924 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2925 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2926
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029283.4. Userlists
2929--------------
2930It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2931http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2932it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2933
2934userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002935 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2937
2938group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002939 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002940 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2941 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2944 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2946 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002947 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2948 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2949 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2950 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002952 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2953 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2954 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2955 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2956 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2957 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2958 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002959 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002960 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002961
2962 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002963 userlist L1
2964 group G1 users tiger,scott
2965 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002967 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2968 user scott insecure-password elgato
2969 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002971 userlist L2
2972 group G1
2973 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2976 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2977 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978
2979 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002980
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
29823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002983----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002984It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002985several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002986instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2987values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2988automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2989In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2990using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2991tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2992reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2993Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2994that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2995each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002996
2997peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002998 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3000
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003001bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3002bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3004 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3005
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006disabled
3007 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3008 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3009 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3010
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003011default-bind [param*]
3012 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3013
3014default-server [param*]
3015 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3016
3017 Arguments:
3018 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3019 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003020 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3021 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3022 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3023 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003024
3025 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3026
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003027enabled
3028 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3029 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003030
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003031log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003032 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3033 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3034 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3035 more details.
3036
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003037peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3038peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003039 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3040 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003041 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003042 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3043 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3044 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003045 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003047 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3049
3050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3052 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3053 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3059 "server" keyword explanation below).
3060
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003061server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3062server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003063 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003064 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003065 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3066 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3067 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003068
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003069 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3070 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3071 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3072 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3073 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003074
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003075 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003078 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3079 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3080 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003081
3082 backend mybackend
3083 mode tcp
3084 balance roundrobin
3085 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3086 stick on src
3087
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003088 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3089 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003090
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003091 Example:
3092 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003093 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3094 default-server ssl verify none
3095 server haproxy1 #local peer
3096 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3097 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003098
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003099
3100table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3102
3103 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3104 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003105 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003106 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3107 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3108 "stick-table" keyword).
3109
3110 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3111 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3112 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3113 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3114 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3115 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3116 of the stick-table name as follows:
3117
3118 peers mypeers
3119 peer A ...
3120 peer B ...
3121 table t1 ...
3122
3123 frontend fe1
3124 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3125
3126 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3127 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3128
3129 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3130 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3131 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3132 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3133 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3134 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3135 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3136
3137 peers mypeers
3138 peer A ...
3139 peer B ...
3140 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3141
3142 backend t1
3143 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3144
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003145 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003146 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3147 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3148
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031493.6. Mailers
3150------------
3151It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3152If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3153in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3154
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003155mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003156 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3157 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3158
3159mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3160 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 mailers mymailers
3164 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3165 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3166
3167 backend mybackend
3168 mode tcp
3169 balance roundrobin
3170
3171 email-alert mailers mymailers
3172 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3173 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3174
3175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3177
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003178timeout mail <time>
3179 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3180 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3181 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3182 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 mailers mymailers
3186 timeout mail 20s
3187 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003188
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031893.7. Programs
3190-------------
3191In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3192master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3193managed the same way as the workers.
3194
3195During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3196sequence as a worker:
3197
3198 - the master is re-executed
3199 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3200 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3201 instance of the program
3202
3203During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3204
3205program <name>
3206 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3207 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3208 the management guide).
3209
3210command <command> [arguments*]
3211 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3212 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3213 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3214 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3215
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003216user <user name>
3217 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3218 See also "group".
3219
3220group <group name>
3221 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3222 See also "user".
3223
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003224option start-on-reload
3225no option start-on-reload
3226 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3227 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3228 program section.
3229
3230
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032313.8. HTTP-errors
3232----------------
3233
3234It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3235imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3236several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3237
3238http-errors <name>
3239 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3240 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3241
3242errorfile <code> <file>
3243 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003247 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003248 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003249
3250 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3251 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3252 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3253 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3254 before any chroot is performed.
3255
3256 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3257
3258 Example:
3259 http-errors website-1
3260 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3261 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3262 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3263
3264 http-errors website-2
3265 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3266 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3267 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3268
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032693.9. Rings
3270----------
3271
3272It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3273servers or traces.
3274
3275ring <ringname>
3276 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3277
3278description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003279 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003280 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3281
3282format <format>
3283 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3284
3285 Arguments:
3286 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3287 one of the following :
3288
3289 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3290 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3291 designed to be used with a local log server.
3292
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003293 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3294 field is stripped. This is the default.
3295 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3296 rfc3164.
3297
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3299 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3300 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3301 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3302 is the default.
3303
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003304 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3306
3307 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3308 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3309
3310 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3311 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3312 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3313 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3314 logger consumes.
3315
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003316 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3317 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3319 with a local log server.
3320
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003321 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3322 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3323 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3324 used with a local log server.
3325
3326maxlen <length>
3327 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3328 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3329 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3330
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003331server <name> <address> [param*]
3332 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3333 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3334 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3335 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3336 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3337 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3338 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3339 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3340 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003341 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3342 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003343
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003344size <size>
3345 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3346 set to BUFSIZE.
3347
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003348timeout connect <timeout>
3349 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3350
3351 Arguments :
3352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3354 as explained at the top of this document.
3355
3356timeout server <timeout>
3357 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3358
3359 Arguments :
3360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3362 as explained at the top of this document.
3363
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003364 Example:
3365 global
3366 log ring@myring local7
3367
3368 ring myring
3369 description "My local buffer"
3370 format rfc3164
3371 maxlen 1200
3372 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003373 timeout connect 5s
3374 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003375 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003376
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033773.10. Log forwarding
3378-------------------
3379
3380It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003381HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003382
3383log-forward <name>
3384 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3385
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003386backlog <conns>
3387 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3388 on connections accept.
3389
3390bind <addr> [param*]
3391 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003392 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3393 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3394 syslog protocol over TCP.
3395 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003396 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3397
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003398dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003399 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3400 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3401 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3402 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003403 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003404
3405log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003406log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3408 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3409 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3412 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3413 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416 Example:
3417 global
3418 log stderr format iso local7
3419
3420 ring myring
3421 description "My local buffer"
3422 format rfc5424
3423 maxlen 1200
3424 size 32764
3425 timeout connect 5s
3426 timeout server 10s
3427 # syslog tcp server
3428 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3429
3430 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003431 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3432 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433 # all messages on stderr
3434 log global
3435 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3436 log ring@myring local0
3437 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3438 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3439 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3440 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3441 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003442
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003443maxconn <conns>
3444 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3445 10 is the default.
3446
3447timeout client <timeout>
3448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034504. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003451----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003453Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003454 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3455 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3456 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3457 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003458
3459A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3460connections.
3461
3462A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3463to forward incoming connections.
3464
3465A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3466parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3467
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003468A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3469ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3470sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3471the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3472explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3473from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3474"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3475for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3476to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3477optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3478are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3479any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3480names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3481that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3482duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3483names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3484
3485Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3486settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3487of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3488profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3489timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3492'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3493case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3494
3495Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3496logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3497proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3498However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3499name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3500
3501Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3502and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003503bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3505modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3506arbitrary criteria.
3507
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3509a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003510the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
3512 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3513 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3514 between responses and new requests.
3515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3517 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3518 client-facing connection remains open.
3519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003520 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3521 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003522
3523The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3524frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3525following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003526weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003528 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003530 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3531 ----+-----+-----+----
3532 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3533 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003534 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3535 ----+-----+-----+----
3536 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003537
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003539only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3540within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003541as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003543and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3544possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003546There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003547first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003548processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003549second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003550protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3551is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3552new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003554process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3555already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3556HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3557evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3558one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3559
3560There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3561performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3562tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3563preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3564analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3565HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3566header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3567mitigate this drawback.
3568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003569There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003570method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3571set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3572in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3573is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3574to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3575above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3576to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3577"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3578frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3579frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3580as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3581upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3582on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3583the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3584upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3585frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3586remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3589--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003591The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3592limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3593they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3594limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003595marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003596option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003597and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3598with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3599specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003601
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3604acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605backlog X X X -
3606balance X - X X
3607bind - X X -
3608bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609capture cookie - X X -
3610capture request header - X X -
3611capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003612clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3613clitcpka-idle X X X -
3614clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003615compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003617declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618default-server X - X X
3619default_backend X X X -
3620description - X X X
3621disabled X X X X
3622dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003623email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003625email-alert mailers X X X X
3626email-alert myhostname X X X X
3627email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628enabled X X X X
3629errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003630errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631errorloc X X X X
3632errorloc302 X X X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3634errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003635force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003636filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637fullconn X - X X
3638grace X X X X
3639hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003640http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003641http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003642http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003644http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003645http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003646http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003647http-check set-var X - X X
3648http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003649http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003651http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003652http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003653http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003655ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003656load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003657log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003658log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003659log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003660log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003661max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003662maxconn X X X -
3663mode X X X X
3664monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665monitor-uri X X X -
3666option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3667option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3668option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3669option allbackups (*) X - X X
3670option checkcache (*) X - X X
3671option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3672option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003673option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003674option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3675option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3677option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003678option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3679option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003680option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003681option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003682option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003683option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003684option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003685option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3687option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3688option httpchk X - X X
3689option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003690option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003692option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003693option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003694option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003695option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3696option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3697option logasap (*) X X X -
3698option mysql-check X - X X
3699option nolinger (*) X X X X
3700option originalto X X X X
3701option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003702option pgsql-check X - X X
3703option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003705option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706option smtpchk X - X X
3707option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3708option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3709option splice-request (*) X X X X
3710option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003711option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3713option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3714-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003715option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003716option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3717option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3718option tcpka X X X X
3719option tcplog X X X X
3720option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003721option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003722external-check command X - X X
3723external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3725rate-limit sessions X X X -
3726redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003727-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003728retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003729retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003730server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003731server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003732server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003734srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3735srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3736srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003737stats admin - X X X
3738stats auth X X X X
3739stats enable X X X X
3740stats hide-version X X X X
3741stats http-request - X X X
3742stats realm X X X X
3743stats refresh X X X X
3744stats scope X X X X
3745stats show-desc X X X X
3746stats show-legends X X X X
3747stats show-node X X X X
3748stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3750stick match - - X X
3751stick on - - X X
3752stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003753stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003754stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003755tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003756tcp-check connect X - X X
3757tcp-check expect X - X X
3758tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003759tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003760tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003761tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003762tcp-check set-var X - X X
3763tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003764tcp-request connection - X X -
3765tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003766tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003767tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003768tcp-response content - - X X
3769tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003770timeout check X - X X
3771timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003772timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003773timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3775timeout http-request X X X X
3776timeout queue X - X X
3777timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003778timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003779timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003780timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003781transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003782unique-id-format X X X -
3783unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003784use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003785use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003786use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003787------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3788 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3792---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
3794This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3795
3796
3797acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3798 Declare or complete an access list.
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 no | yes | yes | yes
3801 Example:
3802 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3803 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3804 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003806 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
3808
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003809backlog <conns>
3810 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | yes | yes | no
3813 Arguments :
3814 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3815 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003816 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003817
3818 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3819 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3820 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3821 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3822 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3823 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3824 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3825 backlog parameter.
3826
3827 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3828 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3829 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3830
3831 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3832
3833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003835balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003836 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | no | yes | yes
3839 Arguments :
3840 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3841 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3842 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3843 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3844
3845 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3846 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3847 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3848 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003849 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003850 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003851 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3852 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3853 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3854 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3855 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3856 it, so that you don't worry.
3857
3858 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3859 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3860 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3861 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3862 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3863 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3864 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3865 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003867 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3868 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3869 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3870 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3871 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3872 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3873 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003874 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3875 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3876 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003877
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003878 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003879 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003880 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3881 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003882 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003883 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3884 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3885 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3886 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3887 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003888 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3889 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3890 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3891 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3892 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3893 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3896 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3897 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3898 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3899 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3900 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3901 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3902 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003903 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003905 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3906 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3907 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003909 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3910 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3911 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3912 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3913 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3914 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3915 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3916 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3917 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3918 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3919 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3920 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003922 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003923 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3924 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3925 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3926 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3927 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3928 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3929 URIs start with a leading "/".
3930
3931 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3932 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3933 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3934 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3935
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003936 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3937 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3938 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3939 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003942 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3943
3944 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003945 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3946 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003947 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3948 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3949 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3950 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003951 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003952 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3953 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003954
3955 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3956 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3957 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3958 server will receive the request.
3959
3960 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3961 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3962 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3963 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3964 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003965 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3966 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3967 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003969 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3970 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3971 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3972 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3973 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003975 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003976 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3977 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3978 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3979
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003980 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3981 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3982 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3983
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003984 random
3985 random(<draws>)
3986 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003987 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3988 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3989 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3990 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003991 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3992 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3993 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3994 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3995 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3996 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3997 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3998 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3999 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4000 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4001 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4002 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4003 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4004 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4005 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4006 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4007 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4008 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4009 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4010 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004011
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004012 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004013 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004014 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4015 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004016 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004017 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4018 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4019 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004020 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004021 used instead.
4022
4023 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4024 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4025 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004026 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004027
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4029 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4030 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004032 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004033 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4034 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004036 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4037 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4038 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004039
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004040 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004041 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004042 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4043 NTLM relies on.
4044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045 Examples :
4046 balance roundrobin
4047 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004048 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004049 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4050 balance hdr(host)
4051 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004052
4053 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4054 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004056 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004057 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4058 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4059 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004060 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004061
4062 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4063 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4064 defaults to 16 kB.
4065
4066 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4067 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4068
4069 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4070 Round Robin.
4071
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004072 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004073 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4074 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4075 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4076
4077 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4078
4079 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004080 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004081 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4082 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4083 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004084
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004085 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004086
4087
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004088bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4089bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 no | yes | yes | no
4093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004094 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4095 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4096 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4097 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004098 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004099 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4100 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4101 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4102 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4103 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4104 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004105 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004106 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4107 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004108 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004109 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4110 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004111 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004112 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4113 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004114 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004115 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4116 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4117 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4118 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4119 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4120 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4121 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004122 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4123 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4124 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004125 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4126 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4127 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4128 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004129 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4130 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4131 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004132
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004133 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4134 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004135 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4136 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4137 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004138 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4139 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4140 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4141 the range.
4142
4143 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4144 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4145 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4146 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4147 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4148 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4149 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004150 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004151 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004153 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004154 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004155 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4156 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4157 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4158 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4159 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4160 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4161
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004162 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4163 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4164 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4165 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4168 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4169 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4170 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4171 in a frontend.
4172
4173 Example :
4174 listen http_proxy
4175 bind :80,:443
4176 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004177 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004179 listen http_https_proxy
4180 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004181 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004182
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004183 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4184 bind ipv6@:80
4185 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4186 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4187
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004188 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004189 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004190
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004191 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4192 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4193 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4194 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4195 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4196
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004197 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004198 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004199
4200
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004201bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004202 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 yes | yes | yes | yes
4205 Arguments :
4206 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4207 may be used to override a default value.
4208
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004209 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210 option may be combined with other numbers.
4211
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004212 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004213 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4214 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4215 missing from all processes.
4216
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004217 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004218 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004219 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4220 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4221 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4222 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4223 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004224 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4227 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4228 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4229 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4230 and 'even' instances.
4231
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004232 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4233 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4234 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4235 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004236
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004237 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4238 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4239
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004240 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4241 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4242 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4243
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004244 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4245 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4246
4247 Example :
4248 listen app_ip1
4249 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004250 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004251
4252 listen app_ip2
4253 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004254 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004255
4256 listen management
4257 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004258 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004259
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004260 listen management
4261 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4262 bind-process 1-4
4263
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004264 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004265
4266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267capture cookie <name> len <length>
4268 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 no | yes | yes | no
4271 Arguments :
4272 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4273 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4274 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4275 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004276 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
4278 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4279 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4280 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4281 right if it exceeds <length>.
4282
4283 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4284 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4285 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4286 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4287
4288 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4289 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4290 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4291
4292 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4293 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4294 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004295 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4296 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4297 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298
4299 Example:
4300 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4301
4302 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004303 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
4305
4306capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004307 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 no | yes | yes | no
4310 Arguments :
4311 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004312 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4314 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4315 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4316
4317 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4318 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4319 it exceeds <length>.
4320
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004321 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4323 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004324 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4325 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4326 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4327 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004328 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004329 environments to find where the request came from.
4330
4331 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4332 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4333 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4334 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004336 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4337 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4338 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4339 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4340 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341
4342 Example:
4343 capture request header Host len 15
4344 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004345 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004347 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348 about logging.
4349
4350
4351capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004352 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 no | yes | yes | no
4355 Arguments :
4356 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004357 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4359 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4360 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4361
4362 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4363 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4364 it exceeds <length>.
4365
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004366 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004367 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4368 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4369 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004370 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4371 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4372 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4373 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004375 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4376 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4377 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4378 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4379 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004380
4381 Example:
4382 capture response header Content-length len 9
4383 capture response header Location len 15
4384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004385 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004386 about logging.
4387
4388
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004389clitcpka-cnt <count>
4390 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4391 the connection on the client side.
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 yes | yes | yes | no
4394 Arguments :
4395 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4396
4397 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4398 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004399 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4400 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004401
4402 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4403
4404
4405clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4406 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4407 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4408 client side.
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | no
4411 Arguments :
4412 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4413 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4414 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4415 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4416
4417 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4418 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004419 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4420 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004421
4422 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4423
4424
4425clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4426 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 yes | yes | yes | no
4429 Arguments :
4430 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4431 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4432 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4433 document.
4434
4435 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4436 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004437 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4438 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004439
4440 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4441
4442
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004443compression algo <algorithm> ...
4444compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004445compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004446 Enable HTTP compression.
4447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | yes | yes | yes
4449 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004450 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4451 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453
4454 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004455 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4456 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4457 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004458
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004459 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004460 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004461
4462 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4463 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4464 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4465 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4466 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004467 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004468
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004469 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4470 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4471 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4472 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4473 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4474 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4475 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004476 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004477
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004478 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004479 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004480 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004481 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004482 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004483 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004484 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004487 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4488 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004489 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4490 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004491 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004492 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004493 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4494 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004495 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004496 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4497 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004498
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004499 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004500 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4501 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004502 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004503 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004504 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4505 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4506 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4507 "multipart"
4508 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4509 header
4510 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4511 and later
4512 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4513 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004514 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004515
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004516 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004517
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004518 Examples :
4519 compression algo gzip
4520 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004522
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004523cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004524 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4525 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004526 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004527 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 yes | no | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4532 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4533 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4534 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4535 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4536 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004537 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4539 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4540
4541 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004542 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004543 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4544 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4545 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4546 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004547 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4548 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004549 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004550 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4551 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552
4553 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004554 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004557 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004558 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004559 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004560 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4561 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4562 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4563 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4564 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4565 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4566 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004567
4568 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4569 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4570 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4571 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4572 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4573 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4574 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4575 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4576 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004577 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004578 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4579 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4580 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004581
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004582 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4583 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4584 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004585 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4586 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4587 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4588 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004589 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4590 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4591 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004592
4593 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4594 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4595 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4596 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4597 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4598 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4599 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4600 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4601 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4602
4603 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4604 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4605 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4606 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4607 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4608 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4609 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4610 persistence cookie in the cache.
4611 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4612
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004613 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4614 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004615 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004616 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4617 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004618 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004619 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4620 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4621 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4622 they logout.
4623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004624 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004625 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4626 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4627 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4628
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004629 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004630 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4631 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4632 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4633 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4634 this attribute.
4635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004636 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004637 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004638 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4639 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4640 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4641 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4642 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4643 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004644
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004645 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4646 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4647 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4648 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4649 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4650 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4651 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4652 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004653 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004654 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4655 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4656 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4657 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4658 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4659 the site.
4660
4661 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4662 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4663 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4664 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4665 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4666 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4667 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4668 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4669 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4670 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4671 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4672 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4673 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004674 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004675 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4676 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4677
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004678 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4679 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4680 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4681 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4682 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4683 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4684
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004685 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004686 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4687 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4688 repeated.
4689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4691 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4692 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4693 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695 Examples :
4696 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4697 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4698 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004699 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004700
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004701 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004702
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004703
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004704declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4705 Declares a capture slot.
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 no | yes | yes | no
4708 Arguments:
4709 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4710
4711 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4712 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4713 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4714 for use in the response.
4715
4716 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004717 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004718 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4719
4720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004721default-server [param*]
4722 Change default options for a server in a backend
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | no | yes | yes
4725 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004726 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4727 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4728 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4729 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004730
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004731 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004732 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4733
4734 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737default_backend <backend>
4738 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 yes | yes | yes | no
4741 Arguments :
4742 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4743
4744 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4745 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4746 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4747 will catch all undetermined requests.
4748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004749 Example :
4750
4751 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4752 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4753 default_backend dynamic
4754
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004755 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004757
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004758description <string>
4759 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | yes | yes | yes
4762 Arguments : string
4763
4764 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4765 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4766 it describes.
4767 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4768
4769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004770disabled
4771 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4777 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4778 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4779 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4780 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4781 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4782 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4783
4784 See also : "enabled"
4785
4786
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004787dispatch <address>:<port>
4788 Set a default server address
4789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004792
4793 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4794 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4795 during start-up.
4796
4797 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4798 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4799 possible with normal servers.
4800
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004801 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004802 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4803 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4804 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4805 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4806
4807 See also : "server"
4808
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004809
4810dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4811 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | no | yes | yes
4814 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4815
4816 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004817 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004818 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4819 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004820 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004821 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823enabled
4824 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | yes
4827 Arguments : none
4828
4829 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4830 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4831
4832 See also : "disabled"
4833
4834
4835errorfile <code> <file>
4836 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | yes | yes | yes
4839 Arguments :
4840 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004841 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004842 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004843
4844 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004845 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004846 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004847 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4848 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849
4850 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4851 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4852 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4853
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004854 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4855
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004856 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4857 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4858 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4859 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4860 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4861 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4862 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4863 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4864 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4867 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4868 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004869 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004870 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4871
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004872 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004873
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004874 Example :
4875 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004876 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004877 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4878 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004881errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4882 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4883 section.
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments :
4887 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4888
4889 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004890 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004891 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4892 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004893
4894 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4895 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4896 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4897 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4898 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004899 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004900 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4901
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004902 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4903 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004904
4905 Example :
4906 errorfiles generic
4907 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4908
4909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910errorloc <code> <url>
4911errorloc302 <code> <url>
4912 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments :
4916 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004917 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004918 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4921 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4922 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4923 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004924 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4927 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4928 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4929
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004930 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4931
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4933 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4934 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4935 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004936 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4938 request.
4939
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004940 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004941
4942
4943errorloc303 <code> <url>
4944 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947 Arguments :
4948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004949 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004950 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004951
4952 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4953 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4954 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4955 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004956 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004957
4958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4965 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4966 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4967 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004968 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004969
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004970 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004971
4972
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004973email-alert from <emailaddr>
4974 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004975 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | yes | yes | yes
4978
4979 Arguments :
4980
4981 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4982
4983 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4984 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004986 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004987 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4988 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004989
4990
4991email-alert level <level>
4992 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4993 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | yes
4996
4997 Arguments :
4998
4999 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5000 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5001 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5002
5003 By default level is alert
5004
5005 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5006 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5007 for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005009 Alerts are sent when :
5010
5011 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5012 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5013 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5014 is notice or lower
5015 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5016 and a health check status update occurs
5017
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005018 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5019 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005020 section 3.6 about mailers.
5021
5022
5023email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5024 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027
5028 Arguments :
5029
5030 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5031
5032 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5033 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5034
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005035 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5036 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005037
5038
5039email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5040 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5041 mailers.
5042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | yes | yes | yes
5044
5045 Arguments :
5046
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005047 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005048
5049 By default the systems hostname is used.
5050
5051 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5052 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5053 for the proxy.
5054
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005055 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5056 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005057
5058
5059email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005060 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005061 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | yes | yes | yes
5064
5065 Arguments :
5066
5067 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5068
5069 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5070 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5071
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005072 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005073 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5074
5075
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005076force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5077 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005079 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005080
5081 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5082 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5083 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5084 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5085 marked down for maintenance operations.
5086
5087 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5088 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5089 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5090 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5091 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5092 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5093 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5094 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5095 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5096
5097 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5098 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5099 is used.
5100
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005101 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005102 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005103
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005104
5105filter <name> [param*]
5106 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 no | yes | yes | yes
5109 Arguments :
5110 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5111 referenced in section 9.
5112
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005113 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005114 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005115 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5116 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005117
5118 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5119 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5120
5121 Example:
5122 listen
5123 bind *:80
5124
5125 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5126 filter compression
5127 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5128
5129 compression algo gzip
5130 compression offload
5131
5132 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5133
5134 See also : section 9.
5135
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005136
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137fullconn <conns>
5138 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | no | yes | yes
5141 Arguments :
5142 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5143 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5144
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005145 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005147 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5149 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5150 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5151 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5152 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005153 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005155 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005156 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005157 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5158 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5159 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005160
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005161 Example :
5162 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5163 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5164 # connections.
5165 backend dynamic
5166 fullconn 10000
5167 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5168 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5169
5170 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5171
5172
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005173grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005174 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005176 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005177 Arguments :
5178 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5179 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5180 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5181
5182 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5183 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005184 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005185 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5186
5187 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5188 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5189 simplify it.
5190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192hash-balance-factor <factor>
5193 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | no | yes
5196 Arguments :
5197 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5198 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005199 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005200
5201 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5202 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5203 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5204 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5205 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5206 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5207 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5208
5209 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5210 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5211 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5212 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5213 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5214
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005215 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5216 consistent hashing mechanism.
5217
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005218 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5219
5220
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005221hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005222 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | no | yes | yes
5225 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005226 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5227 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005228
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5230 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5231 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5232 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5233 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5234 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5235 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5236 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5237 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5238 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005240 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5241 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5242 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5243 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5244 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5245 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5246 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5247 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5248 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5249 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5250 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5251 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5252 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005253 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5254 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005255
5256 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5257
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005258 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005259 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5260 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5261 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005262 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5263 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5264 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005265
5266 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5267 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005268 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5269 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5270 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5271 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5272
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005273 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005274 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5275 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5276 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5277 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5278 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5279 parameter.
5280
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005281 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5282 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5283 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5284 used on strings.
5285
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005286 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5287
5288 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5289 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5290 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5291 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5292 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5293 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5294 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5295 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5296 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5297 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5298 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5299 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005300
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005301 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5302 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5303 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005304
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005305 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005306
5307
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005308http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5309 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5310 ones).
5311
5312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 no | yes | yes | yes
5314
5315 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5316 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5317 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5318 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5319 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5320 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5321
5322 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5323 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5324 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5325
5326 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5327 below.
5328
5329 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5330 instance.
5331
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005332 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5333 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5334 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5335
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005336 Example:
5337 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5338 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5339 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5340
5341http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5342
5343 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5344 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5345 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5346 example, or to pass some internal information.
5347 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5348 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5349 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5350
5351http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5352
5353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5354 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5355
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005356http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005357
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005358 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5359 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5360 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5361 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5362 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005363
5364http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5366
5367 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5368
5369 Example:
5370 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5371
5372 # applied to:
5373 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5374
5375 # outputs:
5376 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5377
5378 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5379
5380http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5382
5383 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5384
5385 Example:
5386 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5387
5388 # applied to:
5389 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5390
5391 # outputs:
5392 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5393
5394http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5395
5396 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5397 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5398 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5399
5400http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5402
5403 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5404 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5405 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5406 fallback.
5407
5408 Example:
5409 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5410 http-response set-status 431
5411 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5412 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5413
5414http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5415
5416 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5417 inline.
5418
5419 Arguments:
5420 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5421 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5422 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5423 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5424 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5425 (request and response)
5426 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5427 processing
5428 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5429 processing
5430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5431 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5432 and '_'.
5433
5434 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5435 followed by some converters.
5436
5437 Example:
5438 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5439
5440http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5441
5442 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5443 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5444 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5445 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5446 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005447 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005448 processing.
5449
5450 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5451 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005452 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005453 rules evaluation.
5454
5455http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5456
5457 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5458 details about <var-name>.
5459
5460 Example:
5461 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5462
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463
5464http-check comment <string>
5465 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5466 it fails.
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | no | yes | yes
5469
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005470 Arguments :
5471 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5472 rule fails.
5473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005474 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5475 user-friendly error reporting.
5476
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005477 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005478 "http-check expect".
5479
5480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005481http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5482 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005483 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005484 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | no | yes | yes
5487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005488 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005489 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5490
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005491 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005492 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493
5494 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5495 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5496 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5497 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5498
5499 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5500
5501 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5502
5503 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5504
5505 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5506
5507 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5508
5509 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5510 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5511 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5512 is used.
5513
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005514 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5515 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5516 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5517 haproxy -vv.
5518
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005519 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5520
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005521 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5522 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5523 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5524 different ports or with different servers.
5525
5526 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5527 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5528 the port with a "http-check connect".
5529
5530 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5531 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5532 do.
5533
5534 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5535 unset-var or comment rules.
5536
5537 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005538 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5539 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5540 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5541 option httpchk
5542
5543 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005544 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005545 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005546 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005547 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005548 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005549
5550 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5551
5552 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005553
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005555http-check disable-on-404
5556 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005559 Arguments : none
5560
5561 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5562 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5563 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5564 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5565 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5566 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5567 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5568 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5570 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005571 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5572 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5573 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005574
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005575 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005576
5577
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005578http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005579 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5580 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5581 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005582 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005584 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005587 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5588
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005589 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5590 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5591 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5592 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5593 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5594 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5595 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5596 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5597 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5598 result is always conclusive.
5599
5600 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5601 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5602 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005603 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5604 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005605 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5606 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005607 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5608 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5609 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005610
5611 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5612 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005613 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5614 supported :
5615 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5616 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005617 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5618 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5619 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5620 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5621 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005622
5623 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5624 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005625 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5626 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5627 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5628 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005629 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5630
5631 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5632 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5633 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5634 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5635
5636 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5637 informational message reported in logs if an error
5638 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5639 log-format string.
5640
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005641 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005642 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5643 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005644 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5645 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5646 details on the supported keywords.
5647
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005648 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5649 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5650 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5651 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005652
5653 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5654 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5655 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5656 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5657 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5658
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005659 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5660 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5661 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5662 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5663 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5664 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5665 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666
5667 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005668 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005669 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5670 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5671 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5672 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5673
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005674 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5675 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005676 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5677 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5678 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5679 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5680 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5681 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5682 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5683 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005684 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5685 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5686 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5687 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5688 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5689 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5690 insensitive on the header names.
5691
5692 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5693 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5694 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5695 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5696 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5697 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005700 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5702 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5703 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5704 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5705 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005706 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005707 trace).
5708
5709 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005711 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5712 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5713 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5714 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5715 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005716 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005717
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005718 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5719 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5720 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5721 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5722 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5723 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5724
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005725 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005726 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005727 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5728 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5729 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5730 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5731 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5732 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5733
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005734 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5735 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5736 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5737 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5738 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005739
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005740 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5741 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5742
5743 Examples :
5744 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005745 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005746
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005747 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5748 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5749
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005750 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005751 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005752
5753 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005754 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005755
5756 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005757 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005758
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005759 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005761
5762
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005763http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005764 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5765 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005766 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5767 health checks.
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | no | yes | yes
5770 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005771 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005773 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5774 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5775 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5776 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5777 to invent non-standard ones.
5778
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005779 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5780 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5781 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5782 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5783
5784 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5785 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5786 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5787 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005788
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005789 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005790 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005791 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5793 to add it.
5794
5795 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5796 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5797 to the log-format rules.
5798
5799 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5800 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5801 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005802
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005803 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5804 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5805 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5806 request.
5807
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005808 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5809 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5810 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005811 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5812 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5813 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5814 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005815 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005816
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005817 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005818 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5819 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005820
5821 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5822 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5823 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5824 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5825 configured request authority.
5826
5827 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5828 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005830 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005831
5832
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005833http-check send-state
5834 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | no | yes | yes
5837 Arguments : none
5838
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005839 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005840 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005841 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5842 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5843 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005844
5845 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5846 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5847 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5848 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5849 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005850 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5851 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5852 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5853
5854 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5855 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5856 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5857
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005858 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5859 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5860 checked in multiple backends.
5861
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005862 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005863 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5864
5865 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5866 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5867 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5868 one fails.
5869
5870 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5871 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5872 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5873
5874 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5875 server's queue.
5876
5877 Example of a header received by the application server :
5878 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5879 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5880
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005881 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5882 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005883
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005884
5885http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5892 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5898 and '-'.
5899
5900 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005902 Examples :
5903 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005904
5905
5906http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005907 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 yes | no | yes | yes
5910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005911 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005912 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5913 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5916 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5919 and '-'.
5920
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005921 Examples :
5922 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005925http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5926 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5927 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5928 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5929 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5931 yes | yes | yes | yes
5932 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005933 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005934 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005935 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005936 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005937
5938 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5939 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5940 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5941 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5942
5943 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5944 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5945 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5946 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5947
5948 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5949 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5950 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5951 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5952 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5953 chroot is performed.
5954
5955 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5956 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5957 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5958 considered.
5959
5960 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5961 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5962 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5963 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5964 considered as a raw string.
5965
5966 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5967 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5968 "content-type".
5969
5970 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5971 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5972 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5973 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5974 evaluated as a log-format string.
5975
5976 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5977 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5978 argument to "content-type".
5979
5980 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5981 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5982 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5983 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5984
5985 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5986 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5987 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5988 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5989 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5990 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5991 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5992 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5993
5994 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5995 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5996 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5997
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005998 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5999 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6000 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6001 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6002 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6003
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006004 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6005 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6006
6007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006009 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6010
6011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 no | yes | yes | yes
6013
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006014 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6015 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6016 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6017 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6018 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6021 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025 Example:
6026 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6027 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6028 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 http-request allow if nagios
6031 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6032 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6033 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006035 Example:
6036 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6037 acl add path /addacl
6038 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6043 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 Example:
6046 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6047 acl setmap path /setmap
6048 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6053 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6056 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6061 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6062 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6063 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6064 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6065 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6066 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6067 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6072 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6073 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6074 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6075 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6076 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6077 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6078 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6083 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006084
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6089 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6090 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6091 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6092 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006093
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006094 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6095 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6096 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6097 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6098 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6099 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6100 instead.
6101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102 Example:
6103 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6104 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006105
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006106http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006107
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006108 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6111 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6114 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6115 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6116 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6117 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6118 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6119 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6120 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6121 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6124 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6125 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006126 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6127
6128 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6129 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6130 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6131 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006133http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006135 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6136 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6137 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6138 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6139 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6140 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006141
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006142http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006143
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006144 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6145 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6146 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6147 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6148 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006150http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6153 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6154 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6155 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6156 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6157 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006158
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006159http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6160http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6161 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6162 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6163 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006165
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006166 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6167 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6168 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006169 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006170 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6171 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6172 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006174 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006175
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006176http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6177 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6178 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6179 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6180
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006181http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6182
6183 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6184 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6185 pointed by <resolvers>.
6186 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6187 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6188 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6189 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6190 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6191 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6192 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6193 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6194 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6195 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006196 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6197 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006198
6199 Example:
6200 resolvers mydns
6201 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6202 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6203 timeout retry 1s
6204 hold valid 10s
6205 hold nx 3s
6206 hold other 3s
6207 hold obsolete 0s
6208 accepted_payload_size 8192
6209
6210 frontend fe
6211 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006212 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006213 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6214
6215 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6216 # which mean DNS resolution error
6217 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6218
6219 default_backend be
6220
6221 backend b_503
6222 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6223 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6224 # 503 error page to end users
6225
6226 backend be
6227 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6228 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6229 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6230 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6231 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6232
6233 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6234 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6235
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006236http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6237
6238 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6239 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6240 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6241 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006242 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6243 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006244
6245 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6246
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006247http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006248http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006249http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006250http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006251http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006252http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006253http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006254http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6255http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006256
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006257 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6258
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006259 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006260 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6261 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6262 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6263 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006264
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006265 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6266 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6267 the supported backend.
6268
6269 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6270 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6271 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6272 number of segments in the path.
6273
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006274 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6275 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6276 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6277 when improperly combined.
6278
6279 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6280 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6281 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6282 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6283 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6284
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006285 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006286
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006287 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6288
6289 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6290 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6291
6292 Example:
6293 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6294
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006295 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6296
6297 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6298 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6299
6300 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6301 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6302
6303 Example:
6304 - /#foo -> /
6305
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006306 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6307 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006308
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006309 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6310 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6311
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006312 Example:
6313 - /. -> /
6314 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6315 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6316 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006317
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006318 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6319 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6320
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006321 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006322 their preceding segment.
6323
6324 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6325 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6326
6327 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6328 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006329
6330 Example:
6331 - /foo/../ -> /
6332 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6333 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6334 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006335 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006336 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006337 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006338
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006339 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6340 removed as well:
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6344 - /bar/../../ -> /
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6347 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - // -> /
6351 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6352
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006353 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6354 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6355
6356 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6357 ".", "_", and "~".
6358
6359 Example:
6360 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6361 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6362 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6363 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6364
6365 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6366 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6367
6368 Example:
6369 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6370 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6371
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006372 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006373 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006374
6375 Example:
6376 - /%6f -> /%6F
6377 - /%zz -> /%zz
6378
6379 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6380 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6381
6382 Example:
6383 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6384
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006385 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006386 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6387 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6388
6389 Example:
6390 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6391 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6392 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006394http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6397 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6398 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6399 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6400 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006402http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006404 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6405 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6406 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6407 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006409http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006411
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006412 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006413 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6414 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6415 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6416 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6417 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006418
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006419 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6420 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6421 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6422 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6423 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006424
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006425 Example:
6426 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6427
6428 # applied to:
6429 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6430
6431 # outputs:
6432 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6433
6434 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006435
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006436 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6437
6438 # applied to:
6439 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006441 # outputs:
6442 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006443
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006444http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
6447 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6448 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006449 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6450 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6451 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006452
6453 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6454 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6455 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6456
6457 Example:
6458 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6459 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6460
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006461 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6462 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6463 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6464 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6465
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006466http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468
6469 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6470 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6471 query-string are replaced.
6472
6473 Example:
6474 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6475 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6476
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006477http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006480 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6481 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6482 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6483 against.
6484
6485 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6486 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6487 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006488
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006489 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6490 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6491 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6492 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6493 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6494 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6495 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6496 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6497 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006498 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6499 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006500
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006501 Example:
6502 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6503 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006504
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006505 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6506 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006508http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6509 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006510
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006511 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6512 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6513 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6514 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006515
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006516 Example:
6517 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006518
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006519 # applied to:
6520 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006521
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006522 # outputs:
6523 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006524
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006525http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6526 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6527 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006528 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6530
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006531 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006532 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6533 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006534 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006535 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006536 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006537 are followed to create the response :
6538
6539 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6540 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6541 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6542 ignored.
6543
6544 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6545 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006546 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006547 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6548 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006549
6550 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6551 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6552 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006553 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006554 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555
6556 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6557 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6558 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006559 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006560 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006561 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006562
6563 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6564 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6565 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6566 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6567 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6568 as a raw content.
6569
6570 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6571 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6572 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6573 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6574 considered as a raw string.
6575
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006576 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006577 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6578 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6579 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6580
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006581 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6582 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006583 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006584
6585 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6586
6587 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006588 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006589 if { path /ping }
6590
6591 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6592 if { path /favicon.ico }
6593
6594 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6595 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6596 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6599http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6602 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6603 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006604
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006605http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6606 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006607
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006608 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6609 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6610 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6611 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6616 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6617 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6618 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6619 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 Arguments:
6622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6623 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 Example:
6626 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6627 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6630 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6635 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6636 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 Arguments:
6639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6640 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 Example:
6643 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6644 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6647 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6648 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006650http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6653 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6654 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6655 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6656 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658 Example:
6659 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6660 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6664 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6665 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6666 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6667 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6672 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6673 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6674 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6675 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6681 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6682 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6683 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6684 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6685 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6686 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6687 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6688 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6693 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6694 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6695 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6696 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6697 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6698 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6703 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6704 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6709 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6710 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6711 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6712 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6713 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6714 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6715 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006717http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6720 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6721 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6722 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6723 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6724 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726 Example :
6727 # prepend the host name before the path
6728 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006729
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006730http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6733 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6734 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6739 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6740 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6741 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6742 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6747 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6748 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6749 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6750 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6751 values have higher priority.
6752 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6753 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6754 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6755 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6756 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6761 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6762 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6763 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6764 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6765 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6766 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006768 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006769
6770 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6772 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6775 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6776 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6777 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006778 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6779 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006780
6781 Arguments :
6782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6783 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006784
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006785 See also "option forwardfor".
6786
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006787 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006788 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6789 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6790
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006791 # After the masking this will track connections
6792 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6793 http-request track-sc0 src
6794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006795 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6796 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6797
6798http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799
6800 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6801 expression.
6802
6803 Arguments:
6804 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6805 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006806
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006807 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006808 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6809 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6810
6811 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6812 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6813 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6814
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006815http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006816 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6817
6818 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6819 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6820 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6821 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6822 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6823
6824 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6825 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6826 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6827 results.
6828
6829 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006830 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6831 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834
6835 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6836 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6837 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6838 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6839 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6840 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6841 information from the request.
6842
6843 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6844
6845http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846
6847 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6848 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006849 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6850 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6851 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6852 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6853 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6855
6856http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857
6858 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6859 inline.
6860
6861 Arguments:
6862 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6863 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6864 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6865 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6866 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6867 (request and response)
6868 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6869 processing
6870 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6871 processing
6872 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6873 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6874 and '_'.
6875
6876 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6877 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006878
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006879 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006880 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006882http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6883 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006885 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6886 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6887 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6888 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6889 agent name must be used.
6890
6891 Arguments:
6892 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6893
6894 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6895 configuration.
6896
6897http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6900 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6901 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6902 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6903 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6904 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6905 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6906 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6907 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6908 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6909 action.
6910 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6911 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6912 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6913 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6914 you fully understand how it works.
6915
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006916http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6917
6918 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6919 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6920 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6921 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6922 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006923 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006924 processing.
6925
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006926 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006927 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6928 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6929 rules evaluation.
6930
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006931http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6933 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6934 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6935 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006937
6938 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6939 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6940 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006941 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6942 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6943 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6944 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6945 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6946 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006947 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006948 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6949 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6950 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006951 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006952 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6953 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6954 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6955 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6956 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006957
6958http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6959http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6960http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6961
6962 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6963 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6964 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6965 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006966 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006967 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6968 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6969 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6970 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6971 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6972 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6973 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6974
6975 Arguments :
6976 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6977 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6978 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6979 select which table entry to update the counters.
6980
6981 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6982 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6983 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6984 that table until the session ends.
6985
6986 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6987 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6988 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6989 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6990 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6991 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6992 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6993 useful information.
6994
6995 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6996 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6997 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6998 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6999 checks that make use of it.
7000
7001http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7002
7003 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007004
7005 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007006 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007007
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007008http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7009
7010 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7011 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7012 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7013 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7014 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7015 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7016
7017 Arguments :
7018 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7019
7020 Example:
7021 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7022
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007023http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7024 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7025
7026 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7027 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7028 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7029 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7030 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7031 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7032 http-buffer-request".
7033
7034 Arguments :
7035
7036 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7037 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7038
7039 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007040 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007041 bytes.
7042
7043 Example:
7044 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7045
7046 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007050 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7051 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7052 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007053
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007056 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7057
7058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 no | yes | yes | yes
7060
7061 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7062 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7063 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7064 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7065 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7066 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7069 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 Example:
7074 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7079 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081 Example:
7082 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007086 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7087 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7090 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7095 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7096 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7097 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7098 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7099 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7100 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7101 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7106 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7107 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7108 example, or to pass some internal information.
7109 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7110 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7111 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7116 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007117
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007118http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007119
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007120 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7125 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7126 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7127 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7128 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7129 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7130 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7133 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7134 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7135 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7136 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007137
7138 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7139 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7140 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7141 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007143http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007145 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7146 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7147 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7148 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7149 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7150 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007151
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007152http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007153
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007154 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7155 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7156 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7157 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7158 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007162 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7163 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7164 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7165 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7166 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7167 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007168
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007169http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7170http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7171 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7172 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7173 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7174 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007175
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007176 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7177 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7178 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007179 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007180 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7181 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7182 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007183 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007184 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007188 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7189 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7190 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7191 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7192 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7193 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007197
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007198 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7199 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007201 Example:
7202 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204 # applied to:
7205 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007207 # outputs:
7208 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007214
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007215 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007216 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 Example:
7219 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221 # applied to:
7222 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224 # outputs:
7225 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007226
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007227http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7228 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7229 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007230 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7232
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007234 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7235 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007236 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007237 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007238 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007239 are followed to create the response :
7240
7241 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7242 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7243 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7244 ignored.
7245
7246 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7247 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007248 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007249 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7250 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251
7252 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7253 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7254 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007255 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007256 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007257
7258 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7259 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7260 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007261 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007262 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007263 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264
7265 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7266 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7267 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7268 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7269 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7270 as a raw content.
7271
7272 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7273 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7274 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7275 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7276 considered as a raw string.
7277
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007278 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7279 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7280 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7281 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7282
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007283 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7284 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007285 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007286
7287 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7288
7289 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007290 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007291 if { status eq 404 }
7292
7293 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7294 string "This is the end !" \
7295 if { status eq 500 }
7296
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007297http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007300 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7301 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7302 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007303
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007304http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007306
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007307 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7308 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7309 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7310 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007311
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007312http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7316 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7317 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7318 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7319 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321 Arguments:
7322 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7325 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007327http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007329 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7330 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7331 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007333http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7334
7335 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7336 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7337 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7338 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7339 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7340
7341http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7342
7343 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7344 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7345 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7346 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7347 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7348 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7349 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7350 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7351 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7352
7353http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7354
7355 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7356 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7357 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7358 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7359 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7360 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7361 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7362
7363http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7364
7365 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7366 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7367 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7368 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7369 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7370 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7371 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7372 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7373
7374http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7376
7377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7380 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007381
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7384 http-response set-status 431
7385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007389
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007390 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7391 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7392 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7393 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7394 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7395 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7396 based on some information from the request.
7397
7398 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7399
7400http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7401
7402 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7403 inline.
7404
7405 Arguments:
7406 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7407 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7408 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7409 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7410 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7411 (request and response)
7412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7413 processing
7414 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7415 processing
7416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7417 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7418 and '_'.
7419
7420 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7421 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007422
7423 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007424 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007426http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7429 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7430 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7431 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7432 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7433 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7434 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7435 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7436 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7437 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7438 action.
7439 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7440 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7441 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7442 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7443 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007444
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007445http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7446
7447 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7448 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7449 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7450 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7451 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007452 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007453 processing.
7454
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007455 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007456 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007457 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007458 rules evaluation.
7459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007460http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7461http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7462http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007464 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7465 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7466 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7467 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7468 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007469 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007470
7471http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7472
7473 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7474 about <var-name>.
7475
7476 Example:
7477 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7478
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007479http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7481
7482 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7483 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7484 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7485 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7486 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7487 buffer is full.
7488
7489 Arguments :
7490
7491 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7492 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7493
7494 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007495 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007496 bytes.
7497
7498 Example:
7499 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007500
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007501http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7502 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7503
7504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7505 yes | no | yes | yes
7506
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007507 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007508 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7509 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7510 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007511
7512 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7513
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007514 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7515 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7516 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7517 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7518 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7519 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7520 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007521 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007522 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7523 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007524
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007525 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7526 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7527 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7528 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7529 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7530 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7531 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007532 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7533 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7534 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7535 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7536 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7537 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007538
7539 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7540 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7541 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7542 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7543 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7544 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7545 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7546 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007547 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007548 downsides of rare connection failures.
7549
7550 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7551 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7552 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7553 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7554 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7555 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007556 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007557 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7558 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7559 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7560 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7561 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7562
7563 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007564 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7565 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7566 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7567 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007568
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007569 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7570 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007571
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007572 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007573
7574 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7575 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7576 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7577
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007578 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7579 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7580 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7581 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7582 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7583 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7584 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7585 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7586 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7587 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7588 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7589
7590 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7591 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7592 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7593 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7594 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7595
7596 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7597 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007598
7599
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007600http-send-name-header [<header>]
7601 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007604 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007605 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7606
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007607 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7608 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7609 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7610 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7611 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7612 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7613 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7614 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7615 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7616 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7617 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7618 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7619 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7620 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7621 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7622 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007623
7624 See also : "server"
7625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007626id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007627 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 no | yes | yes | yes
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7633 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7634 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007635
7636
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007637ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7638 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007640 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007641
7642 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7643 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7644 and running).
7645
7646 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7647 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7648 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007649 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007650 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007652 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7653 "unless" condition is met.
7654
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007655 Example:
7656 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7657 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7658 ignore-persist if url_static
7659
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007660 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7661
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007662load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7663 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | no | yes | yes
7666
7667 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7668 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7669 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007671 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007672 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7673 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7674 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7675
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007676 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007677 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007678 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007679
7680 Arguments:
7681 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7682 named "server-state-file".
7683
7684 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7685 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7686 name is used as a file name.
7687
7688 none don't load any stat for this backend
7689
7690 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007691 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7692 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7693 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007694 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007695 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007696
7697 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7698 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7699
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007700 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007702 global
7703 stats socket /tmp/socket
7704 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007705
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007706 defaults
7707 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007709 backend bk
7710 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7711 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007712
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007713
7714 Then one can run :
7715
7716 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7717
7718 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7719
7720 1
7721 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7722 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7723 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007725 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007726
7727 global
7728 stats socket /tmp/socket
7729 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7730
7731 defaults
7732 load-server-state-from-file local
7733
7734 backend bk
7735 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7736 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7737
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007738
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007739 Then one can run :
7740
7741 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7742
7743 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7744
7745 1
7746 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7747 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7748 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7749
7750 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7751 "show servers state"
7752
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007754log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007755log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007756 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007757no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007758 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007761
7762 Prefix :
7763 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7764 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7765 prefix does not allow arguments.
7766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767 Arguments :
7768 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7769 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7770 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7771 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7772 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7773 parameter.
7774
7775 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7776 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7777
7778 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7779 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7780 standard syslog port).
7781
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007782 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7783 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7784 standard syslog port).
7785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007786 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7787 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7788 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007789 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007791 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7792 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7793 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7794 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7795 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7796 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7797 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7798 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7799 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7800 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7801 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7802 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007803 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007804 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7805 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7806 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007807 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7808 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007809
7810 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7811 and "fd@2", see above.
7812
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007813 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7814 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7815 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7816 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7817 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7818 having the logs instantly available.
7819
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007820 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7821 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7822 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7823
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007824 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7825 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007826
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007827 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7828 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7829 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7830 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7831 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7832 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7833 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7834 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7835 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7836 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007837 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007838
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007839 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7840 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7841 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7842 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7843 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7844
7845 <sample_size>
7846 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7847 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7848 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7849 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7850 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7851
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007852 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7853 one of the following :
7854
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007855 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7856 field is stripped. This is the default.
7857 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7858 rfc3164.
7859
7860 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007861 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7862
7863 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7864 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7865
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007866 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7867 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7868 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7869 designed to be used with a local log server.
7870
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007871 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7872 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7873 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7874 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7875 systemd logger consumes.
7876
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007877 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7878 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7879 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7880 used with a local log server.
7881
7882 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7883 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7884 designed to be used with a local log server.
7885
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007886 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7887 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7888 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7889 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7890
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007891 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7892
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007893 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7894 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7895 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7896
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007897 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7898 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7899 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7900 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007901
7902 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7903 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7904 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007905 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7906 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7907 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7908 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7909 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910
7911 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7912
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007913 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7914 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7915 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007916
7917 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7918 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7919 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7920 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7921
7922 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7923 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924
7925 Example :
7926 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007927 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7928 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7929 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007930 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007931 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7932 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007933 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007935
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007936log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007937 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007940
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007941 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7942 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7943 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7944 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7945 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007946
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007947 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7948 "option httplog" directives.
7949
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007950log-format-sd <string>
7951 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7953 yes | yes | yes | no
7954
7955 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7956 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7957 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7958 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7959 which covers the log format string in depth.
7960
7961 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7962 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7963
7964 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7965 log format to "rfc5424".
7966
7967 Example :
7968 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7969
7970
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007971log-tag <string>
7972 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | yes
7975
7976 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7977 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007978 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007979 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7980 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7981 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7982 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7983 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7984 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007986max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7987 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | no | yes | yes
7990
7991 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7992 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7993 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7994 servers.
7995
7996 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007997 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007998 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7999 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8000 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008002 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8003 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8004 picking a different server.
8005
8006 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8007 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8008 even if they have to be queued.
8009
8010 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8011 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8012
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008013max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8014 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8015 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8016 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008018maxconn <conns>
8019 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | yes | yes | no
8022 Arguments :
8023 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8024 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8025 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8026 closes.
8027
8028 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008029 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008030 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8031 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008032 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8033 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8034 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8035 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008036
8037 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8038 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8039 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8040
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008041 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8042 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008044 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8045
8046
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008047mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | yes | yes | yes
8051 Arguments :
8052 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8053 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8054 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8055 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8056
8057 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8058 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8059 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8060 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8061 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8062
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008063 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8064 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8065 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008066
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008067 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008068 defaults http_instances
8069 mode http
8070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008072monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008073 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076 Arguments :
8077 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8078 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008079 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008080 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8081 backend and its backup.
8082
8083 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8084 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8085 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8086 servers in a list of backends.
8087
8088 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8089 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8090 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008091 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008092 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8093 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008094 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008095 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8096 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008097
8098 Example:
8099 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008100 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008101 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8102 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8103 monitor-uri /site_alive
8104 monitor fail if site_dead
8105
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008106 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008107
8108
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008109monitor-uri <uri>
8110 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | no
8113 Arguments :
8114 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8115 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8116
8117 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8118 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8119 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8120 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8121 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8122 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8123 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8124 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8125
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008126 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008127 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8128 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008129 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8130 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8131 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008132 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8133 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8134 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008135
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008136 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8137 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8138 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8139 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8140
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008141 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008142 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008143 frontend www
8144 mode http
8145 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8146
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008147 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008149
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008150option abortonclose
8151no option abortonclose
8152 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 yes | no | yes | yes
8155 Arguments : none
8156
8157 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8158 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8159 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8160 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008161 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008162 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8163 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8164 encountered while delivering the response.
8165
8166 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8167 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8168 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8169 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8170 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8171 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008174 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8176 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8177 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008179 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8180 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008181 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8182 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8183 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8184 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8185 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8186 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008187 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008188
8189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8191
8192 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8193
8194
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008195option accept-invalid-http-request
8196no option accept-invalid-http-request
8197 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8199 yes | yes | yes | no
8200 Arguments : none
8201
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008202 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008203 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008204 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008205 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8206 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8207 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8208 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8209 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008210 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8211 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8212 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8213 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008215 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008216 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8217 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8218 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008219
8220 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8221 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8222 been confirmed.
8223
8224 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8225 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008226 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8227 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008228 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8229
8230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8232
8233 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8234 stats socket.
8235
8236
8237option accept-invalid-http-response
8238no option accept-invalid-http-response
8239 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8241 yes | no | yes | yes
8242 Arguments : none
8243
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008244 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008245 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008246 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008247 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8248 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8249 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8250 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8251 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008252 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8253 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8254 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008255
8256 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8257 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8258 been confirmed.
8259
8260 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8261 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8262 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8263 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8264
8265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8267
8268 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8269 stats socket.
8270
8271
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008272option allbackups
8273no option allbackups
8274 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | no | yes | yes
8277 Arguments : none
8278
8279 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8280 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8281 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8282 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8283 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8284 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8285 order between the backup servers anymore.
8286
8287 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8288 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8289
8290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8292
8293
8294option checkcache
8295no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008296 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8298 yes | no | yes | yes
8299 Arguments : none
8300
8301 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8302 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008303 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008304 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8305 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008306 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008307
8308 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008309 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008310 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008311 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8312 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008313 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008314 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008315 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8316 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008317 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008318 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8319 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008320 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008321 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8322 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8323 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8324 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8325 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8326 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8327 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8328 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8329 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8330
8331 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008332 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8333 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8334 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8335 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008336
8337 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8338 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008339 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008340 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341
8342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8344
8345
8346option clitcpka
8347no option clitcpka
8348 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8350 yes | yes | yes | no
8351 Arguments : none
8352
8353 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8354 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008355 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008356 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8357
8358 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8359 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8360 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8361 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8362
8363 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8364 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8365 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8366 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8367 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8368
8369 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8370
8371 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8372 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8373 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8374
8375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8377
8378 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8379
8380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008381option contstats
8382 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8384 yes | yes | yes | no
8385 Arguments : none
8386
8387 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8388 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8389 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008390 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008391 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8392 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8393 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8394 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8395 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008396
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008397option disable-h2-upgrade
8398no option disable-h2-upgrade
8399 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8400 connection.
8401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8402 yes | yes | yes | no
8403 Arguments : none
8404
8405 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8406 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8407 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8408 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008409 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8410 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8411 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8412 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8413 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8414 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008415
8416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008418
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008419option dontlog-normal
8420no option dontlog-normal
8421 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8423 yes | yes | yes | no
8424 Arguments : none
8425
8426 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8427 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8428 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8429 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8430 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8431 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8432 logged.
8433
8434 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8435 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8436 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008438 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008439 logging.
8440
8441
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008442option dontlognull
8443no option dontlognull
8444 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8446 yes | yes | yes | no
8447 Arguments : none
8448
8449 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8450 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8451 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8452 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8453 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8454 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008455 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8456 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8457 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008458
8459 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008460 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008461 would not be logged.
8462
8463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8465
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008466 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008467 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008468
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008469
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008470option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008471 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 yes | yes | yes | yes
8474 Arguments :
8475 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8476 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008477 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008478 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008479
8480 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8481 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8482 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8483 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8484 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8485 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8486 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008487 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8488 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8489 possible that the client has already brought one.
8490
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008491 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008492 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008493 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008494 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008495 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008496 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008497
8498 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8499 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8500 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8501 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8502 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8503 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008504 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008505
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008506 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8507 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008508 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008509 are under the control of the end-user.
8510
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008511 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008512 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8513 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008514 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8515 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8516 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008517
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008518 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008519 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8520 frontend www
8521 mode http
8522 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8523
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008524 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8525 backend www
8526 mode http
8527 option forwardfor header X-Client
8528
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008529 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008530 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008531
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008532
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008533option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8534no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8535 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 yes | yes | yes | no
8538 Arguments : none
8539
8540 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8541 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8542 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8543 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8544 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8545 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8546 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8547
8548 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8549 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8550 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8551 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8552 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8553 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8554 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8555 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8556 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8557 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8558
8559 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8560
8561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8563
8564 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8565 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8566
8567
8568option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8569no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8570 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8572 yes | no | yes | yes
8573 Arguments : none
8574
8575 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8576 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8577 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8578 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8579 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8580 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8581 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8582
8583 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8584 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8585 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8586 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8587 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8588 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8589 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8590 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8591 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8592 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8593
8594 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8595
8596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8598
8599 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8600 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8601
8602
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008603option http-buffer-request
8604no option http-buffer-request
8605 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | yes | yes | yes
8608 Arguments : none
8609
8610 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8611 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8612 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8613 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8614 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8615 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008616 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8617 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8618 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8619 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008620
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008621 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8622 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008623
8624
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008625option http-ignore-probes
8626no option http-ignore-probes
8627 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 yes | yes | yes | no
8630 Arguments : none
8631
8632 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8633 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8634 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8635 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8636 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8637 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8638 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8639 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8640 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008641 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8642 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008643 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8644
8645 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8646 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8647 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8648 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8649 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8650 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8651 are often the only way to detect them.
8652
8653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8655
8656 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8657
8658
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008659option http-keep-alive
8660no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008661 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8662 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8664 yes | yes | yes | yes
8665 Arguments : none
8666
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008667 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008668 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8669 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8670 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8671 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8672 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008673
8674 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8675 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008676 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8677 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8678 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8679 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8680 situations where this option may be useful :
8681
8682 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008683 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008684
8685 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8686 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8687
8688 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008689
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008690 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8691 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8692 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8693 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8694 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8695 not set.
8696
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008697 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008698 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008699
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008700 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008701 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008702
8703
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008704option http-no-delay
8705no option http-no-delay
8706 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | yes | yes | yes
8709 Arguments : none
8710
8711 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8712 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8713 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8714 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8715 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8716 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8717 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008718 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008719 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8720 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8721 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8722 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8723 affected.
8724
8725 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8726 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8727 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8728 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8729 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8730 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8731 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8732 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8733 latency environments.
8734
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008735 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8736
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008737
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738option http-pretend-keepalive
8739no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008740 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8741 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008743 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008744 Arguments : none
8745
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008746 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008747 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8748 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8749 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8750 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8751 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8752 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008754 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008755 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008756 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008757 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008758 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008759 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8760
8761 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8762 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8763 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8764 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008765 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8766 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008767 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8768
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008769 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8770 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8771 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008772 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008773
8774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8776
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008777 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008778 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008779
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008780option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8781 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8782 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8784 yes | yes | yes | yes
8785 Arguments :
8786 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8787 with no FastCGI application configured.
8788
8789 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8790 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8791 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8792
8793 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8794 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8795
8796 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8797 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8798 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8799 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8800 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8801 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8802 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8803 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8804
8805 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8806 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008807
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008808option http-server-close
8809no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008810 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | yes | yes | yes
8813 Arguments : none
8814
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008815 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008816 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8817 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8818 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8819 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8820 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8821 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8822 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8823 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8824 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8825 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8826 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8827 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8828 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008829
8830 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8831 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8832 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8833 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008834 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8835 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008836
8837 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8838 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008839 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8840 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8841 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008842
8843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8845
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008846 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8847 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008848
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008849option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008850no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008851 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8853 yes | yes | yes | no
8854 Arguments : none
8855
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008856 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008857 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8858 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8859 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8860 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8861 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008862 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008863
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008864 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008865 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008866 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8867 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8868 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008869
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008870 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8871 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8872 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8873 front of an existing proxy.
8874
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008875 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8876
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008877 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008879option httpchk
8880option httpchk <uri>
8881option httpchk <method> <uri>
8882option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008883 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8885 yes | no | yes | yes
8886 Arguments :
8887 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8888 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8889 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8890 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8891 ones.
8892
8893 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8894 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8895 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8896
8897 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8898 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8899 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008900 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901
8902 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8903 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8904 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8905 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8906 the lack of any response.
8907
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008908 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8909 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8910 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8911 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8912
8913 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8914 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8915 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008916
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008917 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8918 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008919 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008920 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008921 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008923 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8924 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8925 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8926 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8927
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008929 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8930 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8931 backend https_relay
8932 mode tcp
8933 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8934 http-check send hdr Host www
8935 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008936
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008937 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8938 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8939 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940
8941
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008942option httpclose
8943no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008944 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8946 yes | yes | yes | yes
8947 Arguments : none
8948
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008949 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008950 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8951 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8952 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8953 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008954
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008955 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8956 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8957 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8958 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8959 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8960 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8961 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8962 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008963
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008964 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008965 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8966 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008967
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008968 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008969 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008970
8971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8973
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008974 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008975
8976
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008977option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008978 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008980 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008981 Arguments :
8982 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8983 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8984 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008985 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008986 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008987
8988 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8989 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8990 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8991 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8992 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8993 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8994 ports.
8995
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008996 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8997 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008998
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008999 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009001 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009002
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009003
9004option http_proxy
9005no option http_proxy
9006 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | yes | yes | yes
9009 Arguments : none
9010
9011 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9012 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9013 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9014 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9015 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9016
9017 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9018 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009019 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9020 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009021
9022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9024
9025 Example :
9026 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9027 backend direct_forward
9028 option httpclose
9029 option http_proxy
9030
9031 See also : "option httpclose"
9032
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009033
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009034option independent-streams
9035no option independent-streams
9036 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9038 yes | yes | yes | yes
9039 Arguments : none
9040
9041 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9042 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9043 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9044 receive data or not.
9045
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009046 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009047 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9048 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9049 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9050 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9051 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9052 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9053 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9054 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9055 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9056 socket buffers.
9057
9058 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9059 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9060 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9061 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9062 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9063
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009064 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009065
9066
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009067option ldap-check
9068 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 yes | no | yes | yes
9071 Arguments : none
9072
9073 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9074 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9075 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9076 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9077
9078 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9079 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9080
9081 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9082 configure it.
9083
9084 Example :
9085 option ldap-check
9086
9087 See also : "option httpchk"
9088
9089
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009090option external-check
9091 Use external processes for server health checks
9092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9093 yes | no | yes | yes
9094
9095 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9096 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9097 command".
9098
9099 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9100
9101 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9102
9103
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009104option idle-close-on-response
9105no option idle-close-on-response
9106 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9108 yes | yes | yes | no
9109 Arguments : none
9110
9111 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9112 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9113 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9114 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9115 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9116 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9117 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9118 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9119 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9120
9121 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9122 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9123
9124 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9125 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9126 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9127 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9128
9129 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9130 "hard-stop-after"
9131
9132
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009133option log-health-checks
9134no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009135 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9137 yes | no | yes | yes
9138 Arguments : none
9139
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009140 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9141 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9142 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009143
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009144 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9145 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9146 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9147 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9148 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9149
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009151 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009152
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009153 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9154 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9155 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009156
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009157
9158option log-separate-errors
9159no option log-separate-errors
9160 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | no
9163 Arguments : none
9164
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009165 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009166 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9167 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9168 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9169 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9170 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9171 provides very important information.
9172
9173 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9174 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9175 error logs.
9176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009178 logging.
9179
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009180
9181option logasap
9182no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009183 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9185 yes | yes | yes | no
9186 Arguments : none
9187
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009188 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9189 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9190 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9191 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9192
9193 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9194 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9195 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9196 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9197 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009198 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009199 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9200 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9201 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9202 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009203 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009204
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009205 Examples :
9206 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9207 mode http
9208 option httplog
9209 option logasap
9210 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9211
9212 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9213 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9214 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9215 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009217 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009218 logging.
9219
9220
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009221option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009222 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009225 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009226 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9227 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009228 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9229 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009230
9231 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9232 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009234 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009235 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9236 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9237 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009238
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009239 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9240 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9241 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009242
9243 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009245 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9246 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9247 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9248 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9249 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9250 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9251 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9252
9253 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9254 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009255
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009256 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009257
9258 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9259 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9260 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9261 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009262 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009263 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009264
9265 See also: "option httpchk"
9266
9267
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009268option nolinger
9269no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009270 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9272 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009273 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009275 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009276 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9277 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9278 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9279 connections.
9280
9281 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9282 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009283 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9284 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9285 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9286 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9287 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9288 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9289 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9290 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9291 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9292 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9293 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9294 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9295 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009296
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009297 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9298 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9299 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9300 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9301 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009302
9303 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9304 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009305 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009306 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009307 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009308
9309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9311
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009312 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9313 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009315option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9316 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9318 yes | yes | yes | yes
9319 Arguments :
9320 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9321 matching <network>
9322 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9323 header name.
9324
9325 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9326 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9327 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9328 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9329 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9330 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9331 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9332 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9333 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9334 possible that the client has already brought one.
9335
9336 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9337 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9338 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9339 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9340 header and requires different one.
9341
9342 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9343 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9344 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009345 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9346 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9347 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9348 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9349 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009350
9351 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9352 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9353 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9354 both are defined.
9355
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009356 Examples :
9357 # Original Destination address
9358 frontend www
9359 mode http
9360 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9361
9362 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9363 backend www
9364 mode http
9365 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009367 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009368
9369
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009370option persist
9371no option persist
9372 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9374 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009375 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009376
9377 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9378 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9379 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9380 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9381 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9382 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9383 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9384 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9385 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9386 redirected to another valid server.
9387
9388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9390
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009391 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009392
9393
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009394option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009395 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9397 yes | no | yes | yes
9398 Arguments :
9399 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9400 PostgreSQL server.
9401
9402 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9403 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9404 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9405 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9406
9407 See also: "option httpchk"
9408
9409
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009410option prefer-last-server
9411no option prefer-last-server
9412 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9414 yes | no | yes | yes
9415 Arguments : none
9416
9417 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009418 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009419 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9420 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009421 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009422 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009423 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009424 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9425 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009426 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009427 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009428 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9429 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9430 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009431 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9432 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9433 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009434
9435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9437
9438 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9439
9440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009441option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009442option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009443no option redispatch
9444 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9446 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009447 Arguments :
9448 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9449 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9450 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009451 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009452 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009453 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009454 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9455 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9456 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009458
9459 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9460 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9461 be able to access the service anymore.
9462
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009463 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9464 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009465
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009466 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9467 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9468 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9469 following order:
9470
9471 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9472
9473 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9474 list, or
9475
9476 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9477
9478 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9479 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9480
9481 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9482 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9483 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9484 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9485
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009486 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009487 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9488 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009490 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9491 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9492
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009493 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009494
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009495
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009496option redis-check
9497 Use redis health checks for server testing
9498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9499 yes | no | yes | yes
9500 Arguments : none
9501
9502 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9503 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9504 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9505 find the "+PONG" response message.
9506
9507 Example :
9508 option redis-check
9509
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009510 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009511
9512
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009513option smtpchk
9514option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9515 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9517 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009518 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009519 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009520 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009521 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9522
9523 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9524 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9525 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9526
9527 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9528 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9529 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9530 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9531 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9532 dead server.
9533
9534 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9535 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009536 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009537 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9538
9539 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9540 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9541 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9542 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009543 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009544
9545 Example :
9546 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9547
9548 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009551option socket-stats
9552no option socket-stats
9553
9554 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 yes | yes | yes | no
9557
9558 Arguments : none
9559
9560
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009561option splice-auto
9562no option splice-auto
9563 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9565 yes | yes | yes | yes
9566 Arguments : none
9567
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009568 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009569 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009570 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009571 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009572 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009573 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9574 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9575 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9576 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9577
9578 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9579 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9580 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9581 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9582 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9583 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9584 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9585 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9586 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9587 keyword.
9588
9589 Example :
9590 option splice-auto
9591
9592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9594
9595 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9596 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9597
9598
9599option splice-request
9600no option splice-request
9601 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9603 yes | yes | yes | yes
9604 Arguments : none
9605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009606 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009607 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009608 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9609 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9610 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9611 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9612
9613 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9614
9615 Example :
9616 option splice-request
9617
9618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9620
9621 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9622 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9623
9624
9625option splice-response
9626no option splice-response
9627 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9629 yes | yes | yes | yes
9630 Arguments : none
9631
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009632 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009633 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009634 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9635 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9636 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9637 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9638
9639 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9640
9641 Example :
9642 option splice-response
9643
9644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9646
9647 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9648 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9649
9650
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009651option spop-check
9652 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009654 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009655 Arguments : none
9656
9657 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9658 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9659 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9660 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9661
9662 Example :
9663 option spop-check
9664
9665 See also : "option httpchk"
9666
9667
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009668option srvtcpka
9669no option srvtcpka
9670 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9672 yes | no | yes | yes
9673 Arguments : none
9674
9675 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9676 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009678 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9679
9680 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9681 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9682 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9683 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9684
9685 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9686 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9687 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9688 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9689 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9690
9691 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9692
9693 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9694 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9695 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9696
9697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9699
9700 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9701
9702
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009703option ssl-hello-chk
9704 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9706 yes | no | yes | yes
9707 Arguments : none
9708
9709 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9710 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9711 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9712 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9713 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9714 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9715 hello message.
9716
9717 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9718 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9719 messages, which is appreciable.
9720
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009721 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009722 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9723 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009724
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009725 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9726
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009727
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009728option tcp-check
9729 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9731 yes | no | yes | yes
9732
9733 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9734 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9735
9736 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9737 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9738 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9739
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009740 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9742 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9743 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9744 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9745 only.
9746
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009747 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009748 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9750 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9751 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9752
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009753 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9755 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009756 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009757 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9758 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9759 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9760 the respective protocols.
9761 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009763
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009764 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009765
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009766 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9767 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9768 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9769 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009770
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009771 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9772 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9773 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009774
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009775
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009776 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009777 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009778 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009779 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009782 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009783 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009784
9785 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9786 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009787 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009788 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009789 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009790 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009791 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009792 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009793 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9794 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009795 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009796 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9797 tcp-check expect string +OK
9798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009799 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009800 (send many headers before analyzing)
9801 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009802 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009803 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9804 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9805 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9806 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009807 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009808
9809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009810 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009811
9812
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009813option tcp-smart-accept
9814no option tcp-smart-accept
9815 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9817 yes | yes | yes | no
9818 Arguments : none
9819
9820 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9821 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9822 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9823 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9824 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9825 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9826
9827 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9828 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9829 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9830 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9831
9832 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9833 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9834 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009836
9837 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9838 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9839 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9840
9841 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9842 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9843 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9844
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009845 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9846
9847
9848option tcp-smart-connect
9849no option tcp-smart-connect
9850 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9852 yes | no | yes | yes
9853 Arguments : none
9854
9855 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9856 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9857 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9858 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9859 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9860
9861 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9862 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9863 complex.
9864
9865 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9866 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9867 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9868
9869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9871
9872 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9873
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009874
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009875option tcpka
9876 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9878 yes | yes | yes | yes
9879 Arguments : none
9880
9881 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9882 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009883 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009884 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9885
9886 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9887 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9888 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9889 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9890
9891 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9892 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9893 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9894 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9895 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9896
9897 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9898
9899 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9900 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9901 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9902 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9903 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9904 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9905 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9906 backends.
9907
9908 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9909
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009910
9911option tcplog
9912 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009914 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009915 Arguments : none
9916
9917 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9918 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9919 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9920 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9921 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9922 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9923 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9924 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9925
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009926 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009928 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009929
9930
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009931option transparent
9932no option transparent
9933 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009935 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009936 Arguments : none
9937
9938 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9939 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9940 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9941 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9942 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9943 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9944 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9945 appropriate server.
9946
9947 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9948 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9949
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009950 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009951 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009952
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009953
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009954external-check command <command>
9955 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9957 yes | no | yes | yes
9958
9959 Arguments :
9960 <command> is the external command to run
9961
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009962 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9963
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009964 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009965
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009966 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9967 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9968 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9969 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9970 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9971 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009972
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009973 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9974
9975 Environment variables :
9976 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9977 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9978
9979 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9980
9981 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9982
9983 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9984 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9985 for a UNIX socket).
9986
9987 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9988
9989 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9990
9991 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9992
9993 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9994
9995 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9996
9997 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9998 socket).
9999
10000 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10001 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10002
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010003 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10004
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010005 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10006 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10007 failed.
10008
10009 Example :
10010 external-check command /bin/true
10011
10012 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10013
10014
10015external-check path <path>
10016 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10018 yes | no | yes | yes
10019
10020 Arguments :
10021 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10022
10023 The default path is "".
10024
10025 Example :
10026 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10027
10028 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10029 "external-check command"
10030
10031
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010032persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010033persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010034 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | no | yes | yes
10037 Arguments :
10038 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010039 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10040 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010041
10042 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10043 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010044 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010045 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10046 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10047 forwarded to this server.
10048
10049 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10050 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10051 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010052 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010053 a single "listen" section.
10054
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010055 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10056 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10057 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10058
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010059 Example :
10060 listen tse-farm
10061 bind :3389
10062 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10063 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10064 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10065 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10066 persist rdp-cookie
10067 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010068 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010069 balance rdp-cookie
10070 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10071 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10072
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010073 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010074
10075
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010076rate-limit sessions <rate>
10077 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10079 yes | yes | yes | no
10080 Arguments :
10081 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10082 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10083
10084 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10085 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10086 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010087 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010088 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10089 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10090
10091 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10092 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10093 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10094 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10095
10096 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10097 listen smtp
10098 mode tcp
10099 bind :25
10100 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010101 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010102
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010103 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10104 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10105 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010106
10107 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10108
10109
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010110redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10111redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10112redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010113 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10115 no | yes | yes | yes
10116
10117 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010118 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010119
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010121 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010122 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10123 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10124 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010125
10126 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10127 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10128 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10129 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10130 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010131 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10132 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10133 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10134 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010135
10136 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10137 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10138 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10139 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10140 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10141 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010142 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010143 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010144 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10145 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10146 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010147
10148 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010149 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10150 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10151 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010152 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010153 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10154 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10155 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10156 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010157
10158 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010159 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010160
10161 - "drop-query"
10162 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10163 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10164 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10165 with a location-type redirect.
10166
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010167 - "append-slash"
10168 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10169 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10170 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10171 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10172
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010173 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10174 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10175 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10176 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10177 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10178 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10179 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10180
10181 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10182 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10183 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10184 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10185 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10186 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10187 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010188
10189 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10190 acl clear dst_port 80
10191 acl secure dst_port 8080
10192 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010193 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010194 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010195 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10196
10197 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010198 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10199 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10200 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010201 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010202
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010203 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10204 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10205 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10206
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010207 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010208 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010209
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010210 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010211 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10212 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10213 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010215 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010216
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010217
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010218retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010219 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10221 yes | no | yes | yes
10222 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010223 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10224 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010225
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010226 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10227 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10228 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10229 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10230 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010231
10232 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010233 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010234 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010235
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010236 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10237 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10238 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010239
10240 See also : "option redispatch"
10241
10242
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010243retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010244 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10245 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10246 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10248 yes | no | yes | yes
10249 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010250 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10251 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10252 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10253 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10254 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010255
10256 none never retry
10257
10258 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10259 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10260
10261 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10262 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10263 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10264 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10265 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10266 processing the request.
10267
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010268 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10269 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10270 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10271 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10272 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10273 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10274 overflow attack for example).
10275
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010276 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10277 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10278 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10279 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10280 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10281 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10282 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10283 amplify denial of service attacks.
10284
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010285 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10286 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10287 considered to be safe to retry.
10288
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010289 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10290 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10291 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10292 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10293 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010294
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010295 all-retryable-errors
10296 retry request for any error that are considered
10297 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10298 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10299 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10300
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010301 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10302 not cumulative.
10303
10304 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10305 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10306 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10307 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10308
10309 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10310 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10311 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10312 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10313 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10314 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10315 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10316 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10317 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10318 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10319 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10320 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10321
10322 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10323 should not use this directive.
10324
10325 The default is "conn-failure".
10326
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010327 Example:
10328 retry-on 503 504
10329
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010330 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10331
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010332server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010333 Declare a server in a backend
10334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10335 no | no | yes | yes
10336 Arguments :
10337 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010338 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010339 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010340
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010341 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10342 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10343 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10344 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010345 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10346 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010347 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010348 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10349 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010350 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10351 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10352 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10353 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10354 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10355 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10356 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010357 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010358 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10359 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10360 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10361 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10362 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10363 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010364 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10365 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010366 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10367 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010368
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010369 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010370 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10371 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10372 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10373 adding this value to the client's port.
10374
10375 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10376 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010377 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010378
10379 Examples :
10380 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10381 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010382 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010383 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10384 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10385 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010386
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010387 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10388 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10389 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10390 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10391 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10392
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010393 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10394 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010395
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010396server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010397 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010398 this backend.
10399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10400 no | no | yes | yes
10401
10402 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10403 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10404 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10405 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10406 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010407
10408 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10409 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10410
10411 global
10412 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10413
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010414 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010415 load-server-state-from-file
10416
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010417 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010418 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010419
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010420server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10421 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10422 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10424 no | no | yes | yes
10425
10426 Arguments:
10427 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10428
10429 <num | range>
10430 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10431 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10432 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10433 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10434
10435 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10436
10437 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10438
10439 <params*>
10440 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10441 keyword.
10442
10443 Examples:
10444 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10445 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10446 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10447
10448 # or
10449 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10450
10451 # would be equivalent to:
10452 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10453 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10454 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10455
10456
10457
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010458source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010459source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010460source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010461 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10463 yes | no | yes | yes
10464 Arguments :
10465 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10466 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010467
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010468 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010469 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10470 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10471 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10472 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10473 supported prefixes are :
10474 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10475 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10476 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010477 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010478 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10479 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010480
10481 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10482 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010483 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10484 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10485 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486
10487 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10488 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10489 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10490 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10491 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10492 <addr>.
10493
10494 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10495 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10496 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10497 port.
10498
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010499 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10500 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10501 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10502 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010503 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010504 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10505 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10506 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10507 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10508 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10509 HTTP header.
10510
10511 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10512 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010513 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010514 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10515 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10516 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10517 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10518 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10519 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10520 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10521
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010522 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10523 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10524 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10525 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10526 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10527 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10528
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010529 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10530 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10531 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10532 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10533
10534 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10535 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10536 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10537 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10538 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10539 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10540
10541 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10542 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10543 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10544 there are two methods :
10545
10546 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10547 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10548 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10549 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10550 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10551 of the client ranges may be used.
10552
10553 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10554 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10555 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10556 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10557 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10558 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10559 same session.
10560
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10562 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10563 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010564 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010565
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010566 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010568 Examples :
10569 backend private
10570 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10571 source 192.168.1.200
10572
10573 backend transparent_ssl1
10574 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10575 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10576
10577 backend transparent_ssl2
10578 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10579 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10580 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10581
10582 backend transparent_ssl3
10583 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10584 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10585 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10586
10587 backend transparent_smtp
10588 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10589 # with Tproxy version 4.
10590 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10591
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010592 backend transparent_http
10593 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10594 # proxy.
10595 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010597 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010598 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10599
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010600
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010601srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10602 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10603 the connection on the server side.
10604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10605 yes | no | yes | yes
10606 Arguments :
10607 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10608
10609 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10610 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010611 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10612 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010613
10614 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10615
10616
10617srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10618 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10619 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10620 server side.
10621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10622 yes | no | yes | yes
10623 Arguments :
10624 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10625 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10626 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10627 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10628
10629 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10630 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010631 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10632 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010633
10634 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10635
10636
10637srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10638 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10640 yes | no | yes | yes
10641 Arguments :
10642 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10643 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10644 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10645 document.
10646
10647 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10648 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010649 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10650 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010651
10652 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10653
10654
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010655stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10656 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010658 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010659
10660 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10661 matched.
10662
10663 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10664 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10665
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010666 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10667 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010668 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010669
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010670 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10671 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10672 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10673 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010674
10675 Example :
10676 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10677 backend stats_localhost
10678 stats enable
10679 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10680
10681 Example :
10682 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10683 backend stats_auth
10684 stats enable
10685 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10686 stats admin if TRUE
10687
10688 Example :
10689 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10690 userlist stats-auth
10691 group admin users admin
10692 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10693 group readonly users haproxy
10694 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10695
10696 backend stats_auth
10697 stats enable
10698 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10699 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10700 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10701 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10702
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010703 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10704 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10705 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010706
10707
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010708stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10709 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010711 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010712 Arguments :
10713 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10714
10715 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10716
10717 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10718 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10719 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10720 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10721 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10722 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10723
10724 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10725 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10726 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010727 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010728
10729 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10730 report using "stats scope".
10731
10732 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10733 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10734 unobvious parameters.
10735
10736 Example :
10737 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10738 backend public_www
10739 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10740 stats enable
10741 stats hide-version
10742 stats scope .
10743 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010745 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10746 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10747
10748 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10749 backend private_monitoring
10750 stats enable
10751 stats uri /admin?stats
10752 stats refresh 5s
10753
10754 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10755
10756
10757stats enable
10758 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010760 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010761 Arguments : none
10762
10763 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10764 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10765 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10766 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10767 - stats auth : no authentication
10768 - stats scope : no restriction
10769
10770 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10771 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10772 unobvious parameters.
10773
10774 Example :
10775 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10776 backend public_www
10777 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10778 stats enable
10779 stats hide-version
10780 stats scope .
10781 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010782 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010783 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10784 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10785
10786 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10787 backend private_monitoring
10788 stats enable
10789 stats uri /admin?stats
10790 stats refresh 5s
10791
10792 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10793
10794
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795stats hide-version
10796 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010798 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010799 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010800
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010801 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10802 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10803 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10804 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10805 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10806 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010808 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10809 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10810 unobvious parameters.
10811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010812 Example :
10813 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10814 backend public_www
10815 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010816 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010817 stats hide-version
10818 stats scope .
10819 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010820 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010821 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10822 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010823
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010824 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10825 backend private_monitoring
10826 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010827 stats uri /admin?stats
10828 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010829
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010830 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010831
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010832
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010833stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10835 Access control for statistics
10836
10837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10838 no | no | yes | yes
10839
10840 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10841 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10842 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10843 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10844 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10845 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10846
10847 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10848 instance.
10849
10850 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10851 about ACL usage.
10852
10853
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010854stats realm <realm>
10855 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010857 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010858 Arguments :
10859 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10860 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10861 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10862
10863 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10864 using a backslash ('\').
10865
10866 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10867 only related to authentication.
10868
10869 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10870 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10871 unobvious parameters.
10872
10873 Example :
10874 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10875 backend public_www
10876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10877 stats enable
10878 stats hide-version
10879 stats scope .
10880 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010882 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10883 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10884
10885 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10886 backend private_monitoring
10887 stats enable
10888 stats uri /admin?stats
10889 stats refresh 5s
10890
10891 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10892
10893
10894stats refresh <delay>
10895 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010897 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010898 Arguments :
10899 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10900 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10901 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10902 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10903 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10904 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10905
10906 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10907 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10908 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010909 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010910
10911 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10912 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10913 unobvious parameters.
10914
10915 Example :
10916 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10917 backend public_www
10918 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10919 stats enable
10920 stats hide-version
10921 stats scope .
10922 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010923 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010924 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10925 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10926
10927 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10928 backend private_monitoring
10929 stats enable
10930 stats uri /admin?stats
10931 stats refresh 5s
10932
10933 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10934
10935
10936stats scope { <name> | "." }
10937 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010939 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940 Arguments :
10941 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10942 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10943 section in which the statement appears.
10944
10945 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10946 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10947 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10948 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10949 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10950 exists.
10951
10952 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10953 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10954 unobvious parameters.
10955
10956 Example :
10957 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10958 backend public_www
10959 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10960 stats enable
10961 stats hide-version
10962 stats scope .
10963 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010964 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010965 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10966 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10967
10968 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10969 backend private_monitoring
10970 stats enable
10971 stats uri /admin?stats
10972 stats refresh 5s
10973
10974 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010977stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010978 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010981
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010982 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10984
10985 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10986 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10987
10988 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10989 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010991
10992 Example :
10993 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10994 backend private_monitoring
10995 stats enable
10996 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10997 stats uri /admin?stats
10998 stats refresh 5s
10999
11000 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11001 global section.
11002
11003
11004stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011005 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11007 yes | yes | yes | yes
11008 Arguments : none
11009
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011010 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11012 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11013 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11014 - IP (socket, server)
11015 - cookie (backend, server)
11016
11017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011020
11021 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11022
11023
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011024stats show-modules
11025 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11027 yes | yes | yes | yes
11028 Arguments : none
11029
11030 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11031 values as a tooltip.
11032
11033 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11034 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11035 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11036
11037 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11038
11039
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011040stats show-node [ <name> ]
11041 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011043 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011044 Arguments:
11045 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11046 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11047
11048 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11049 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011050 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011051
11052 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11053 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11054 unobvious parameters.
11055
11056 Example:
11057 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11058 backend private_monitoring
11059 stats enable
11060 stats show-node Europe-1
11061 stats uri /admin?stats
11062 stats refresh 5s
11063
11064 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11065 section.
11066
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011067
11068stats uri <prefix>
11069 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011071 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011072 Arguments :
11073 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11074 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11075 query string.
11076
11077 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11078 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11079 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11080 possible to reach it in the application.
11081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011082 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011083 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011084 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11085 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11086 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11087 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11088
11089 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11090 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11091 an address or a port to statistics only.
11092
11093 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11094 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11095 unobvious parameters.
11096
11097 Example :
11098 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11099 backend public_www
11100 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11101 stats enable
11102 stats hide-version
11103 stats scope .
11104 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011106 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11107 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11108
11109 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11110 backend private_monitoring
11111 stats enable
11112 stats uri /admin?stats
11113 stats refresh 5s
11114
11115 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11116
11117
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011118stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11119 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011121 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011122
11123 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011124 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011125 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011126 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011127 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11128
11129 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11130 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11131 the "stick-table" statement.
11132
11133 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11134 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11135 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11136 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11137 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11138
11139 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11140 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11141 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11142 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11143 transformation rules.
11144
11145 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11146 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11147 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11148 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11149 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11150 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11151 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11152
11153 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11154 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11155 ACL based conditions.
11156
11157 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11158 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11159 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11160 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11161
11162 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11163 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11164 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11165 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11166
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011167 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11168 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011169 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011170
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011171 Example :
11172 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11173 # last 30 minutes
11174 backend pop
11175 mode tcp
11176 balance roundrobin
11177 stick store-request src
11178 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11179 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11180 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11181
11182 backend smtp
11183 mode tcp
11184 balance roundrobin
11185 stick match src table pop
11186 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11187 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11188
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011189 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011190 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011191
11192
11193stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11194 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11196 no | no | yes | yes
11197
11198 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11199 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11200 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11201 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011203 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11204 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011205 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011206
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207 Examples :
11208 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011209 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011210
11211 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11212 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11213 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11214
11215
11216 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11217 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11218 backend http
11219 mode http
11220 balance roundrobin
11221 stick on src table https
11222 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11223 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11224 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11225
11226 backend https
11227 mode tcp
11228 balance roundrobin
11229 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11230 stick on src
11231 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11232 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11233
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011234 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011235
11236
11237stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11238 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11240 no | no | yes | yes
11241
11242 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011243 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011244 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011245 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011246 server is selected.
11247
11248 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11249 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11250 the "stick-table" statement.
11251
11252 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11253 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11254 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11255 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11256 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11257 address.
11258
11259 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11260 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11261 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11262 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11263 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11264 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11265 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11266 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11267 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11268 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11269
11270 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11271 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11272 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11273 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11274 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11275 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11276 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11277
11278 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11279 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11280 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11281 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11282
11283 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11284 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11285 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11286 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11287 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11288 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011289 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11290 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11291 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11292 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11293 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11294 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011295
11296 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11297 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11298 the request.
11299
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011300 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11301 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011303
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011304 Example :
11305 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11306 # last 30 minutes
11307 backend pop
11308 mode tcp
11309 balance roundrobin
11310 stick store-request src
11311 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11312 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11313 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11314
11315 backend smtp
11316 mode tcp
11317 balance roundrobin
11318 stick match src table pop
11319 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11320 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011322 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011323 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324
11325
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011326stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011327 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011328 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011329 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011331 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011332
11333 Arguments :
11334 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11335 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11336 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11337 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11338
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011339 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11340 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11341 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11342 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11343
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11345 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11346 instance.
11347
11348 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11349 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11350 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11351 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11352 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11353 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011354 to 32 characters.
11355
11356 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11357 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11358 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011359 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011360 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11361 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011362
11363 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011364 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11365 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011366 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11367 increase.
11368
11369 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011370 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11371 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11372 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011373
11374 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011375 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011376 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11377 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011378 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011379 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11380 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11381 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11382 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11383 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11384 parameter (see below).
11385
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011386 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11387 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11388 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11389 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11390 soft restart.
11391
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011392 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11393 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011394
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011395 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011396 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11397 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011398 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11399 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011400 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011401 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011402 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11403 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011404 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11405 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011406
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011407 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11408 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11409 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11410 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11411 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11412 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11413 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11414 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11415 token.
11416
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011417 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11418 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11419 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11420 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011421 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11422 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11423 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11424 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11425 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11426 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11427 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11428 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11429 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11430 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11431 types and their arguments.
11432
11433 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11434 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11435 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11436 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11437
11438 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11439 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11440 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011441 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011442
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011443 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11444 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11445 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011446 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011447 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011448 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011449
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011450 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11451 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11452 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11453 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11454
11455 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11456 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11457 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11458 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11459 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11460 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11461
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011462 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11463 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11464 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11465 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11466
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011467 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11468 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11469 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11470 they were received.
11471
11472 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11473 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11474 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11475 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11476 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11477
11478 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11479 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11480 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11481 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11482 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11483
11484 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11485 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11486 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11487
11488 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11489 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11490 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11491 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11492 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11493
11494 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11495 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11496 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11497 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11498 the client side.
11499
11500 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11501 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11502 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11503 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11504 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11505 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11506 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11507
11508 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11509 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11510 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11511 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11512 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11513 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011514 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011515
11516 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11517 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11518 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11519 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11520 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11521 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11522
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011523 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11524 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11525 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11526 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11527 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11528
11529 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11530 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11531 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11532 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11533 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11534 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11535
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011536 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011537 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011538 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11539 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11540
11541 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11542 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11543 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11544 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11545 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11546 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11547 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11548 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11549 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11550 recommended for better fairness.
11551
11552 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011553 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011554 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11555 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11556
11557 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11558 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11559 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11560 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11561 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11562 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11563 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11564 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11565 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11566 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011567
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011568 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11569 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011570 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11571 reference it.
11572
11573 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11574 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011575 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11576 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11577 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011578
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011579 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11580 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11581 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11582 something that can be ignored.
11583
11584 Example:
11585 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11586 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11587 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11588 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11589
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011590 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011591 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011592
11593
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011594stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011595 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11597 no | no | yes | yes
11598
11599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011600 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011601 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011602 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011603 server is selected.
11604
11605 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11606 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11607 the "stick-table" statement.
11608
11609 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11610 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11611 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11612 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11613
11614 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11615 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11616 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11617 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11618 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11619 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011620 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011621 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11622 rules.
11623
11624 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11625 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11626 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11627 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11628 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11629 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11630 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11631
11632 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11633 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11634 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11635 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11636
11637 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11638 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11639 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11640 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11641 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11642 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011643 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11644 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11645 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11646 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11647 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11648 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11649 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11650 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11651 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011652
11653 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11654
11655 Example :
11656 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11657 backend https
11658 mode tcp
11659 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011660 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011661 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011662
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011663 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11664 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665
11666 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11667 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11668 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11669
11670 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11671 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011672
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011673 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11674 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11675 # at offset 44.
11676
11677 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011678 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011679
11680 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011681 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011682
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011683 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11684 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11685
11686 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11687 extraction.
11688
11689
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011690tcp-check comment <string>
11691 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11692 it fails.
11693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11694 yes | no | yes | yes
11695
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011696 Arguments :
11697 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11698 rule fails.
11699
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011700 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11701 user-friendly error reporting.
11702
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011703 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11704 "tcp-check expect".
11705
11706
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011707tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11708 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011709 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011710 Opens a new connection
11711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011713
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011714 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011715 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11716
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011717 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011718 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011719
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011720 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011721 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11722 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011723 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011724
11725 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011726
11727 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11728
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011729 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11730
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011731 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11732
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011733 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11734
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011735 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11736 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11737 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11738 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11739
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011740 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11741 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11742 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11743 haproxy -vv.
11744
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011745 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011746
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011747 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11748 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11749 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11750
11751 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11752 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11753 of the sequence.
11754
11755 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11756 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11757 do.
11758
11759 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11760 unset-var or comment rules.
11761
11762 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011763 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11764 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11765 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11766 option tcp-check
11767 tcp-check connect
11768 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11769 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11770 tcp-check send \r\n
11771 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11772 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11773 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11774 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11775 tcp-check send \r\n
11776 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11777 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11778
11779 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11780 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011781 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011782 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11783 tcp-check connect port 143
11784 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11785 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11786
11787 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11788
11789
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011790tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011791 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011792 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011793 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011794 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011796 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011797
11798 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011799 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11800
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011801 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11802 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11803 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11804 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11805 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11806 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11807 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11808 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11809 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11810 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11811
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011813 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11814 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011815 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11816 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11817 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11818
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011819 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11820 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11821 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011822 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11823 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011824 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11825 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011826 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11827 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011828 By default "L7OK" is used.
11829
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011830 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11831 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011832 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11833 supported :
11834 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11835 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011836 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11837 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11838 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11839 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11840 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011841
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011842 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011843 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011844 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11845 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11846 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11847 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011848 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11849
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011850 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11851 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11852 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11853 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11854
11855 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11856 informational message reported in logs if an error
11857 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11858 log-format string.
11859
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011860 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11861 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11862 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11863 followed by some converters.
11864
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011865 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11866 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11867 with the usual backslash ('\').
11868 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011869 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011870 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11871 used upper or lower case.
11872
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011873 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11874
11875 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11876 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11877 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11878 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11879 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11880 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11881 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11882 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11883
11884 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11885 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11886 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11887 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11888 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11889 expression.
11890
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011891 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11892 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11893 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11894 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11895 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11896 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11897
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011898 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11899 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11900 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11901 this exact hexadecimal string.
11902 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11903
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011904 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11905 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11906 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11907 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11908 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11909 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11910 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11911 size.
11912
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011913 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11914 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11915 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11916 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11917 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11918 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11919 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11920 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11921 in a binary string before matching the response's
11922 buffer.
11923
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011924 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011925 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011926 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11927 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11928 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11929 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11930 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11931 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11932 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11933 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11934 the null character.
11935
11936 Examples :
11937 # perform a POP check
11938 option tcp-check
11939 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11940
11941 # perform an IMAP check
11942 option tcp-check
11943 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11944
11945 # look for the redis master server
11946 option tcp-check
11947 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011948 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11950 tcp-check expect string role:master
11951 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11952 tcp-check expect string +OK
11953
11954
11955 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011956 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011957
11958
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011959tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11960tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11961 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11962 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011964 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011965
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011966 Arguments :
11967 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11968
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011969 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11970 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011971
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011972 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11973 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011974
11975 Examples :
11976 # look for the redis master server
11977 option tcp-check
11978 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11979 tcp-check expect string role:master
11980
11981 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011982 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011983
11984
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011985tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11986tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11987 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11988 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011991
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011992 Arguments :
11993 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011994
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011995 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11996 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011997
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011998 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11999 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12000 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012001
12002 Examples :
12003 # redis check in binary
12004 option tcp-check
12005 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12006 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12007
12008
12009 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012010 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012011
12012
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012013tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012014 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012016 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012017
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012018 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012019 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12020 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12023 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12025 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12026 and '-'.
12027
12028 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12029
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012030 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012031 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12032
12033
12034tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012035 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012037 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012038
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012039 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012040 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12041 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12042 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12043 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12044 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12045 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12046 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12047 and '-'.
12048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012049 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012050 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12051
12052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012053tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12054 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12056 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012057 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012058 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12059 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012061 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012062
12063 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12064 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012065 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12066 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12067 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12068 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12069 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12070 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012072 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12073 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12074 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12075 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012076
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012077 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012078 - accept :
12079 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12080 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12081 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012083 - reject :
12084 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12085 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12086 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12087 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12088 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12089 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12090 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12091 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12092 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12093 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12094 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012095 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012096
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012097 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12098 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12099 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12100 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12101 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12102 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12103 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12104 hosts.
12105
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012106 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12107 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12108 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12109 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12110 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12111 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12112 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12113 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12114
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012115 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12116 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12117 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12118 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12119 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12120 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12121 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12122 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12123 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012124 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12125 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012126
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012127 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012129 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12130 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12131 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012132 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012133 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012134 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12135 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12136 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12137 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12138 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12139 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12140 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012142 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012143 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012144 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012146 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12147 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12148 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012150 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12151 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12152 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12153 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012154
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012155 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12156 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12157 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12158 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12159 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012160 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12161 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12162 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12163 layer7 information is extracted.
12164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012165 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12166 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12167 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12168 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12169 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012170
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012171 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12172 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12173 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12174 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12175
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012176 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12177 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12178 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12179 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12180
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012181 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12182 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12183 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12184 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12185 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012186
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012187 - set-src <expr> :
12188 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12189 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12190 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012191 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012193 Arguments:
12194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12195 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012196
12197 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012198 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12199
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012200 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12201 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012202
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012203 - set-src-port <expr> :
12204 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12205 expression.
12206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012207 Arguments:
12208 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12209 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012210
12211 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012212 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12213
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012214 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12215 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12216 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012217
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012218 - set-dst <expr> :
12219 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12220 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12221 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12222 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12223 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12224
12225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12226 followed by some converters.
12227
12228 Example:
12229
12230 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12231 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12232
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012233 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12234 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12235
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012236 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12237 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12238 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12239 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12240
12241
12242 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12243 followed by some converters.
12244
12245 Example:
12246
12247 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12248
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012249 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12250 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12251 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12252
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012253 - "silent-drop" :
12254 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012255 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012256 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12257 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12258 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12259 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12260 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012261 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12262 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012263 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12264 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012265 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012266 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12267 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12268 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12269 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12272 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12273 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12276 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12277 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012280 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012281 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12284 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12285 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012288 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12289 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012290
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012291 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12292
12293 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12294
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012295 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12296
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012297 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012298
12299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012300tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12301 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012303 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012304 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012305 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12306 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012308 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012310 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12312 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012313 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12314 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012316 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12317 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12318 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12319 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012320 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012321 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012322 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12323 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12324 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12325 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012326 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012327 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012329 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12330 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12331 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12332 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012333
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012334 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012335 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012336 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012337 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12338 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012339 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012340 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012341 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012342 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012343 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012344 - set-dst <expr>
12345 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012346 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012347 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012348 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012349 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012350 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012351 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012352
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012353 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12354 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012355 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12356 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012357
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012358 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12359 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12360 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12361 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12362 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12363 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012365 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012366 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12367 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012368
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012369 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12370 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12371 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12372 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12373 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12374 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012376 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012377 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12378 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12379 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12380 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12381 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12382 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12383 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12384 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12385 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12386 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012387
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012388 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012389 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12390 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12391 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012392
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012393 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12394 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12395
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012396 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012397 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12398 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012399
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012400 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12401 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012402 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012403 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12404 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012405 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012406 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012407 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012408 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12409 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012410 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012411 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12412 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012413
12414 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12415 followed by some converters.
12416
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012417 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012418 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12419 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12420 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12421 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12422 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12423 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012424 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012425 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12426 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12427
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012428 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12429
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012430 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12431 <var-name>.
12432
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012433 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12434 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12435 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12436 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12437 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12438
12439 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12440 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12441 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12442 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12443 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12444 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12445 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12446 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12447 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12448 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12449 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12450
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012451 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12452 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12453 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12454 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12455 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12456
12457 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12458
12459 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12460
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012461 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12462 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12463 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12464 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12465 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12466 evaluated.
12467
12468 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012469 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012470
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012471 Example:
12472
12473 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012474 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012475
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012476 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012477 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012478 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012479 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12480 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012481 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012482 tcp-request content reject
12483
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012484 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12485 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12486 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12487 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12488 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12489 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12490 ...
12491 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012493 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012494 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12495 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012496 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012497 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012498
12499 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12500 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012501 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012502 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012503 tcp-request content reject
12504
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012505 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012506 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012507 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012508 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012509 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12510 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012511
12512 Example:
12513 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12514 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012515 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012517 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012518 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012519
12520 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012521 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012522 # protecting all our sites
12523 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012524 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12525 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012526 ...
12527 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12528
12529 backend http_dynamic
12530 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012531 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012532 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012533 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012534 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012535 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012536 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012538 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012539
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012540 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12541 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012542
12543
12544tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12545 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012547 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012548 Arguments :
12549 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12550 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12551 as explained at the top of this document.
12552
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012553 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012554 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12555 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12556 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12557 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12558
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012559 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12560 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12561 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12562 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012564 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012565 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012566 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012567 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012568 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012569 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12570 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12571 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012572
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012573 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12574 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12575
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012576 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12577 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12578 it pass through unaffected.
12579
12580 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12581 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12582 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012583 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012584 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12585 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012586 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12587 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12588 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012589
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012590 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012591 "timeout client".
12592
12593
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012594tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12595 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12597 no | no | yes | yes
12598 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012599 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12600 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012601
12602 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012604 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012605 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12606 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012607 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12608 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012609
12610 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12611
12612 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12613 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12614 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12615 inserted.
12616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012617 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012618 - accept :
12619 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12620 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12621 the rules evaluation.
12622
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012623 - close :
12624 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12625 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12626 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12627 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12628 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12629 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012630 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012631 protocols.
12632
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012633 - reject :
12634 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12635 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012636 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012637
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012638 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012639 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012640
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012641 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12642 Unsets a variable.
12643
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012644 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12645 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12646 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12647 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12648
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012649 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12650 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12651 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12652 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12653
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012654 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12655 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12656 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12657 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12658 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012659
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012660 - "silent-drop" :
12661 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012662 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012663 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12664 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12665 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12666 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12667 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12669 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012670 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12671 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012672 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012673 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12674 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12675 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12676 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12677
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012678 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12679 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12680
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012681 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12682 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12683 for changing the default action to a reject.
12684
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012685 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12686 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12687 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12688 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012689 period.
12690
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012691 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12692 declared inline.
12693
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012694 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12695 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012699 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012701 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012702 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12703 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012704 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012705 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12706 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012707
12708 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12709 followed by some converters.
12710
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012711 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12712 <var-name>.
12713
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012714 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12715 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12716 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12717 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12718 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12719
12720 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12721
12722 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12723
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012724 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12725
12726 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12727
12728
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012729tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12730 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12732 no | yes | yes | no
12733 Arguments :
12734 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12735 below.
12736
12737 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012739 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012740 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12741 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12742 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12743 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12744 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12745 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12746 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012747 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012748 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12749 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12750 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12751 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12752 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12753 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12754 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12755 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12756 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12757 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12758 instead.
12759
12760 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12761 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12762 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12763 rules which may be inserted.
12764
12765 Several types of actions are supported :
12766 - accept : the request is accepted
12767 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12768 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12769 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012770 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012771 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012772 - set-dst <expr>
12773 - set-dst-port <expr>
12774 - set-src <expr>
12775 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012776 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012777 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012778 - silent-drop
12779
12780 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12781 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12782 sections for a complete description.
12783
12784 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12785 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12786 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12787
12788 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12789 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12790 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12791 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12792 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12793
12794 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12795 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12796
12797 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12798 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12799 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12800
12801 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12802 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12803 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12804
12805 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12806 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12807 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12808
12809 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12810 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12811 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12812
12813 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12814
12815 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12816
12817
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012818tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12819 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12821 no | no | yes | yes
12822 Arguments :
12823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12825 as explained at the top of this document.
12826
12827 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12828
12829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012830timeout check <timeout>
12831 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12832 established.
12833
12834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12835 yes | no | yes | yes
12836 Arguments:
12837 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12838 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12839 as explained at the top of this document.
12840
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012841 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012842 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012843 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012844 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012845 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12846 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12847 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012848
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012849 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012850 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12851
12852 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12853 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012854 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012855
12856 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12857 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12858 forget about it.
12859
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012860 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12861 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012862
12863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012864timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12867 yes | yes | yes | no
12868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12871 as explained at the top of this document.
12872
12873 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12874 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12875 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012876 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12877 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12878 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12879 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12881 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12882 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012883 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012885 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12886 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012887 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12888 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012889
12890 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12891 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12892 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12893 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012894 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012895 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12896
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012897 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012899
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012900timeout client-fin <timeout>
12901 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12903 yes | yes | yes | no
12904 Arguments :
12905 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12906 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12907 as explained at the top of this document.
12908
12909 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12910 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12911 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12912 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12913 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12914 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12915 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012916 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12917 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12918 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012919
12920 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12921 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12922 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12923
12924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12925
12926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012927timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12930 yes | no | yes | yes
12931 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12934 as explained at the top of this document.
12935
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012936 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012937 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012938 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012939 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012940 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12941 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012942
12943 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12944 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12945 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12946 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012947 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012948 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12949
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012950 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012952
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012953timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12954 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12956 yes | yes | yes | yes
12957 Arguments :
12958 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12960 as explained at the top of this document.
12961
12962 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12963 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12964 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12965 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12966 once the request has started to present itself.
12967
12968 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12969 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12970 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12971 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12972 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12973
12974 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12975 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12976 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12977 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12978
12979 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12980 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012982 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12983 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012984 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012985
12986 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12987 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12988 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12989 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12990
12991 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12992
12993
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012994timeout http-request <timeout>
12995 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012997 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012998 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13001 as explained at the top of this document.
13002
13003 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13004 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13005 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13006 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13007 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13008 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13009 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013010 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13011 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13012 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13013 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013014 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013015 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13016 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013017
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013018 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13019 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13020 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13021 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13022 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013023 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013024
13025 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13026 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013027 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013028 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13029 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13030
13031 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013032 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13033 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13034 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013035
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013036 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013037 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013038
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013039
13040timeout queue <timeout>
13041 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13043 yes | no | yes | yes
13044 Arguments :
13045 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13046 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13047 as explained at the top of this document.
13048
13049 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13050 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13051 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13052 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13053 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13054
13055 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13056 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13057 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13058 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13059
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013060 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013061
13062
13063timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013064 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13066 yes | no | yes | yes
13067 Arguments :
13068 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13069 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13070 as explained at the top of this document.
13071
13072 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13073 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13074 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13075 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13076 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13077 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13078 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13079
13080 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13081 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13082 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13083 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13084 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013085 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013086 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013087 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13088 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013089 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13090 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013091
13092 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13093 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13094 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13095 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013096 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013097 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13098
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013099 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013100
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013101
13102timeout server-fin <timeout>
13103 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13105 yes | no | yes | yes
13106 Arguments :
13107 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13108 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13109 as explained at the top of this document.
13110
13111 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13112 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13113 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13114 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13115 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13116 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13117 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13118 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13119 situations, it should not be needed.
13120
13121 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13122 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13123 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13124
13125 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13126
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013127
13128timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013129 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13131 yes | yes | yes | yes
13132 Arguments :
13133 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13135 as explained at the top of this document.
13136
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013137 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13138 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13139 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013140
13141 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13142 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13143 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13144 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013145 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013146
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013147 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013148
13149
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013150timeout tunnel <timeout>
13151 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13153 yes | no | yes | yes
13154 Arguments :
13155 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13156 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13157 as explained at the top of this document.
13158
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013159 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013160 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13161 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13162 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013163 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13164 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013165 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13166 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13167 specified.
13168
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013169 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13170 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13171 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13172 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13173 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13174 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13175 state.
13176
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013177 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13178 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13179 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13180 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013181 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013182
13183 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13184 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13185 forget about it.
13186
13187 Example :
13188 defaults http
13189 option http-server-close
13190 timeout connect 5s
13191 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013192 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013193 timeout server 30s
13194 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13195
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013196 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013197
13198
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013199transparent (deprecated)
13200 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013202 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013203 Arguments : none
13204
13205 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13206 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13207 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13208 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13209 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13210 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13211 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13212 appropriate server.
13213
13214 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13215
13216 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13217 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13218
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013219 See also: "option transparent"
13220
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013221unique-id-format <string>
13222 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13224 yes | yes | yes | no
13225 Arguments :
13226 <string> is a log-format string.
13227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013228 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13229 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13230 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13231 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013232
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013233 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013234 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013235 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13236 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13237 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13238 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13239 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13240 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013241
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013242 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13243 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013244
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013245 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013246
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013247 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013248
13249 will generate:
13250
13251 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13252
13253 See also: "unique-id-header"
13254
13255unique-id-header <name>
13256 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13258 yes | yes | yes | no
13259 Arguments :
13260 <name> is the name of the header.
13261
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013262 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13263 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013264
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013265 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013266
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013267 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013268 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13269
13270 will generate:
13271
13272 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13273
13274 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013275
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013276use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013277 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13279 no | yes | yes | no
13280 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013281 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13282 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013283
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013284 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13285 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013286
13287 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13288 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13289 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013290 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013291 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013292 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13293 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013294
13295 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13296 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13297 assign the backend.
13298
13299 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13300 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13301 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13302 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13303 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13304 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13305
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013306 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013307 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013308 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13309 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13310 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13311
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013312 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13313 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13314 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13315 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13316 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13317 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13318 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13319 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13320 cannot be forced from the request.
13321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013322 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013323 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13324 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13325
13326 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13327 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013328
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013329use-fcgi-app <name>
13330 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13332 no | no | yes | yes
13333 Arguments :
13334 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13335
13336 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013337
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013338use-server <server> if <condition>
13339use-server <server> unless <condition>
13340 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13342 no | no | yes | yes
13343 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013344 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13345 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013346
13347 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13348
13349 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13350 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13351 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13352
13353 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13354 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13355 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13356 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13357 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13358 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13359 matches will assign the server.
13360
13361 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13362 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13363 with the next rules until one matches.
13364
13365 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13366 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13367 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13368 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13369
13370 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13371 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13372 stripped.
13373
13374 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13375 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013376 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013377 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013378 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013379
13380 Example :
13381 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013382 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013383 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013384 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013385 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013386 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013387 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013388 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13389 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13390
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013391 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13392 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13393 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13394 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013395 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013396 and we fall back to load balancing.
13397
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013398 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013399
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013400
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134015. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013402--------------------------
13403
13404The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13405depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13406settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13407written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13408described in this section.
13409
13410
134115.1. Bind options
13412-----------------
13413
13414The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13415as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13416no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13417parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13418while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13419provided immediately after the setting name.
13420
13421The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13422
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013423accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13424 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13425 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13426 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13427 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13428 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13429 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13430 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13431 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13432 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013433 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13434 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13435 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013436
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013437accept-proxy
13438 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013439 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13440 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013441 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13442 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13443 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13444 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013446 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13447 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013448 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13449 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013451allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013452 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013453 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013454 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013455 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13456 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013457
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013458alpn <protocols>
13459 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13460 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13461 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013462 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013463 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013464 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13465 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13466 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13467 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13468 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13469 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13470 preference, like below :
13471
13472 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013473
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013474backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013475 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013476 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13477
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013478curves <curves>
13479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13480 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13481 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13482 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13483 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13484 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13485
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013486ecdhe <named curve>
13487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013488 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13489 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013490
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013491ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13493 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13494 client's certificate.
13495
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013496ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13498 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13499 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13500 error is ignored.
13501
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013502ca-sign-file <cafile>
13503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13504 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13505 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13506 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13507 'generate-certificates' for details.
13508
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013509ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013510 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13511 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13512 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13513 'generate-certificates' for details.
13514
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013515ca-verify-file <cafile>
13516 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13517 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13518 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13519 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13520 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13521
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522ciphers <ciphers>
13523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13524 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013525 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013526 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013527 information and recommendations see e.g.
13528 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13529 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13530 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13531
13532ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13534 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13535 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13536 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013537 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13538 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013539
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013540crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13542 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013543 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13544 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013545
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013546crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13548 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13549 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13550 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13551 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013552 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13553 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013554
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013555 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13556 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13557
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013558 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13559 are loaded.
13560
13561 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013562 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13563 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13564 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13565 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13566 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13567 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13568 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013569 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13570 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013571
13572 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13573 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13574 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13575 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013576 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13577 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013578
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013579 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013580
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013581 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013582 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13584 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013585 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13586 clients).
13587
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013588 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013589 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13590 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13591 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13592 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13593 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13594 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13595 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13596 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13597 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13598 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13599 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13600 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13601
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013602 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013603 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13604 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13605 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13606 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13607
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013608 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13609 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13610 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13611 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013612
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013613 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13614 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13615 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013616
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013617crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013619 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013620 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013621 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013622
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013623crt-list <file>
13624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013625 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13626 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013627
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013628 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13629
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013630 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13631 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13632 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13633 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13634 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013635
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013636 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013637 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13638 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13639 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13640 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13641 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013642 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13643 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13644 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013645
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013646 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13647 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13648 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013649
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013650 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13651
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013652 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013653 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013654 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13655 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13656 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13657 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13658 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13659 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013660
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013661 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013662 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013663 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013664 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013665 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013666 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013668defer-accept
13669 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13670 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13671 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013672 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013673 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13674 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13675 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13676 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13677 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13678 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13679 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13680
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013681expose-fd listeners
13682 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13683 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013684 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13685 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013686 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013687
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013688force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013689 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013690 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013691 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013692 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013693
13694force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013695 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013696 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013697 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013698
13699force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013700 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013701 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013702 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013703
13704force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013705 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013706 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013707 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013708
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013709force-tlsv13
13710 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13711 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013712 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013713
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013714generate-certificates
13715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13716 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13717 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13718 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13719 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13720 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13721 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13722 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13723 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13724 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13725 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13726
13727 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13728 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013729 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013730 certificate is used many times.
13731
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013732gid <gid>
13733 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13734 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13735 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13736 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13737 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13738
13739group <group>
13740 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13741 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13742 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13743 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13744 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13745
13746id <id>
13747 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13748 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13749 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13750 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13751
13752interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013753 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13754 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13755 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13756 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13757 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13758 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013759 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13760 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13761 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13762 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13763 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13764 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013765
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013766level <level>
13767 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13768 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13769 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013771 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13772 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13773 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013775 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013776 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013777 all counters).
13778
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013779severity-output <format>
13780 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13781 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13782 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13783 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13784 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13785 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13786 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13787 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13788 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13789 rfc5424 convention.
13790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013791maxconn <maxconn>
13792 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13793 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13794 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13795 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13796 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13797 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13798 eat all memory.
13799
13800mode <mode>
13801 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13802 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13803 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13804 UNIX sockets.
13805
13806mss <maxseg>
13807 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13808 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13809 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13810 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13811 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13812 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13813 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13814 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13815 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13816 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13817 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13818
13819name <name>
13820 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13821 page.
13822
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013823namespace <name>
13824 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13825 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13826 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13827 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013829nice <nice>
13830 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13831 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13832 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13833 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13834 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13835 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13836 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13837 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13838 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13839 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13840 one for an RDP socket.
13841
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013842no-ca-names
13843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13844 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013845 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013847no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013849 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013850 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013851 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013852 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13853 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013855no-tls-tickets
13856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13857 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13858 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013859 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013861 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13862 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13863 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013864
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013865no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013867 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013868 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013869 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013870 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13871 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013873no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013875 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013876 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013877 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013878 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13879 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013880
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013881no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013883 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013884 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013885 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013886 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13887 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013888
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013889no-tlsv13
13890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13891 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13892 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13893 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013894 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13895 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013896
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013897npn <protocols>
13898 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13899 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13900 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013901 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013902 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013903 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13904 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13905 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13906 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13907 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013908
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013909prefer-client-ciphers
13910 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13911 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13912 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013913 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13914 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13915 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013916
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013917process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013918 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013919 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013920 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013921 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13922 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13923 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13924 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013925 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013926 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13927 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13928 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13929 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13930 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013931
13932 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13933
13934 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13935 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13936 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13937 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13938 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13939 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13940 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13941 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013942
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013943proto <name>
13944 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13945 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13946 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013947 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13948 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13949
13950 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13951 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13952 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13953 also reported (flag=HTX).
13954
13955 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13956 a bind line :
13957
13958 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13959 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13960 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13961
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013962 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013963 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013964 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013965 h2" on the bind line.
13966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013967ssl
13968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013969 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013970 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13971 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013972 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13973 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013974
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013975ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13976 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013977 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13978 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13979 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013980 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13981
13982ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013983 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13984 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13985 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13986 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013987
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013988strict-sni
13989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13990 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013991 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
13992 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
13993 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
13994 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
13995 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013996
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013997tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013998 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013999 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014000 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014002 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14003 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14004 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14005 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14006 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14007 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14008 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14009
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014010tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014011 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014012 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14013 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14014 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14015 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14016 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14017 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14018 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014019 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14020 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14021 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014022
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014023tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14024 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014025 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14026 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14027 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14028 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14029 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14030 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14031 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14032 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14033 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14034 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014035 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14036 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14037
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014038transparent
14039 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14040 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14041 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14042 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14043 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14044 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14045 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14046 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14047 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14048 so check for support with your vendor.
14049
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014050v4v6
14051 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14052 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14053 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14054 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014055 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014056
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014057v6only
14058 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14059 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14060 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014061 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14062 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014064uid <uid>
14065 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14066 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14067 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14068 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14069 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14070
14071user <user>
14072 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14073 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14074 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14075 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14076 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14077
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014078verify [none|optional|required]
14079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14080 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14081 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14082 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14083 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014084 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14085 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14086 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14087 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140895.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014090------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014092The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14093which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14094arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14095settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14096after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14097Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14098address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014100 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014101 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014102
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014103Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14104keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014106The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014107
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014108addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014109 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014110 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14111 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14112 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14113 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14114 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014115
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116agent-check
14117 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014118 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014119 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14120 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14121 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014122
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014123 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014124 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014125 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014126 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14127 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014128
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014129 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14130 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14131 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14132 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14133 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014134
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014135 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014136 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014137
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014138 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14139 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14140 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014142 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14143 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14144 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014145
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014146 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014147 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14148 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14149 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14150 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014151 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014152 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014153
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014154 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14155 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014156
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014157 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14158 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14159 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14160 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14161 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14162 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14163 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14164 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14165 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014166
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014167 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14168 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014169 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14170 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14171 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014172 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014173
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014174 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014175 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014176
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014177agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014178 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014179 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14180 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14181 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14182 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14183
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014184agent-inter <delay>
14185 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14186 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14187
14188 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14189 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14190 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14191 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14192 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14193 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14194 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14195 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14196 of backends use the same servers.
14197
14198 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14199
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014200agent-addr <addr>
14201 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14202
14203 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014204 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014205 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14206 hostname, it will be resolved.
14207
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014208agent-port <port>
14209 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14210
14211 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14212
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014213allow-0rtt
14214 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014215 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14216 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014217
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014218alpn <protocols>
14219 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14220 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14221 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014222 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014223 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14224 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14225 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14226 now obsolete NPN extension.
14227 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14228 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14229
14230 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14231
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014232 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014234backup
14235 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14236 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14237 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14238 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014239 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14240 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014241
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014242ca-file <cafile>
14243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14244 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14245 server's certificate.
14246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014247check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014248 This option enables health checks on a server:
14249 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14250 considered available.
14251 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14252 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14253 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14254 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14255 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14256 set.
14257 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14258 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14259 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14260 exchanges succeed.
14261
14262 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14263 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14264 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14265 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14266 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014267 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014268 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14269
14270 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14271 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14272
14273 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14274 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14275
14276 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14277 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14278 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14279 available.
14280
14281 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14282 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14283 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14284
14285 Example:
14286 # simple tcp check
14287 backend foo
14288 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14289 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14290 backend foo
14291 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14292 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14293 backend foo
14294 option tcp-check
14295 tcp-check connect
14296 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014297
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014298check-send-proxy
14299 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14300 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14301 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14302 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14303 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14304 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14305 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14306
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014307check-alpn <protocols>
14308 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14309 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14310 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14311
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014312check-proto <name>
14313 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14314 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14315 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014316 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14317 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14318
14319 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14320 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14321 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14322 also reported (flag=HTX).
14323
14324 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14325 directive on a server line:
14326
14327 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14328 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14329 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14330 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14331
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014332 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014333 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14334 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14335
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014336check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014337 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014338 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14339 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014340
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014341check-ssl
14342 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14343 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14344 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14345 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014346 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014347 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14348 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014349 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014350 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14351 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014352
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014353check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014354 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014355 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14356 for normal traffic.
14357
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014358ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14360 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14361 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014362 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14363 information and recommendations see e.g.
14364 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14365 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14366 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014367
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014368ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14370 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14371 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14372 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014373 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14374 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14375 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014377cookie <value>
14378 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14379 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14380 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14381 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14382 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14383 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14384 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14385
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014386crl-file <crlfile>
14387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14388 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14389 to verify server's certificate.
14390
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014391crt <cert>
14392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14393 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14394 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14395 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14396 certificate request.
14397
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014398 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14399 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14400 option is set accordingly).
14401
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014402disabled
14403 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14404 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14405 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14406 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14407 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014408 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014409
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014410enabled
14411 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14412 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14413 default value.
14414 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14415 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014417error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014418 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14419 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14420 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014422 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014424fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014425 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14426 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14427 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14428
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014429force-sslv3
14430 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14431 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014432 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014433 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014434
14435force-tlsv10
14436 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014437 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014438 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014439
14440force-tlsv11
14441 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014442 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014443 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014444
14445force-tlsv12
14446 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014447 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014448 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014449
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014450force-tlsv13
14451 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14452 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014453 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014455id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014456 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14457 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14458 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014459
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014460init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14461 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14462 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014463 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014464 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14465 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14466 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14467 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14468 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14469 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14470 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14471 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14472 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014473 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014474 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14475 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14476 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14477 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14478 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14479 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014480 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014481
14482 Example:
14483 defaults
14484 # never fail on address resolution
14485 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014487inter <delay>
14488fastinter <delay>
14489downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014490 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14491 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14492 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14493 between checks depending on the server state :
14494
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014495 Server state | Interval used
14496 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14497 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14498 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14499 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14500 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14501 or yet unchecked. |
14502 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14503 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14504 | "inter" otherwise.
14505 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014507 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14508 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14509 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14510 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014511 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14512 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14513 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14514 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14515 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014516
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014517log-proto <logproto>
14518 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14519 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14520 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14521 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014523maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014524 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14525 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014526 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14527 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14529 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14530 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14531 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14532
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014533 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14534 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14535 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14536 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14537 than 50 concurrent requests.
14538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014539maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014540 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14541 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14542 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14543 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014544 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14545 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14546 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14547 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14548 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14549 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14550 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014551
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014552max-reuse <count>
14553 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14554 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14555 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14556 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14557 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14558 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14559 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14560 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014562minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014563 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14564 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14565 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14566 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14567 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14568 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014569 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014570 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014571
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014572namespace <name>
14573 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14574 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14575 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14576 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14577
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014578no-agent-check
14579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14583 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14584
14585no-backup
14586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14588 default value.
14589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14590 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14591
14592no-check
14593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14595 default value.
14596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14597 "default-server" "check" setting.
14598
14599no-check-ssl
14600 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14601 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14602 default value.
14603 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14604 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14605
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014606no-send-proxy
14607 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14608 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14609 default value.
14610 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14611 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14612
14613no-send-proxy-v2
14614 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14615 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14616 default value.
14617 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14618 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14619
14620no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14621 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14622 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14623 default value.
14624 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14625 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14626
14627no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14628 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14629 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14630 default value.
14631 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14632 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14633
14634no-ssl
14635 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14636 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14637 default value.
14638 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14639 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14640
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014641 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14642 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14643 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14644
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014645no-ssl-reuse
14646 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14647 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14648 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14649 and for paranoid users.
14650
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014651no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014652 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14653 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014654 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014655
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014656 Supported in default-server: No
14657
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014658no-tls-tickets
14659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14660 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14661 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014662 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14663 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014664 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14665 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14666 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014667 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014668
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014669no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014670 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014671 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14672 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014673 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14674 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014675 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014676
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014677 Supported in default-server: No
14678
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014679no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014680 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014681 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14682 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014683 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14684 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014685 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014686
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014687 Supported in default-server: No
14688
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014689no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014690 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014691 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14692 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014693 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14694 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014695 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014696
14697 Supported in default-server: No
14698
14699no-tlsv13
14700 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14701 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14702 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14703 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14704 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014705 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014706
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014707 Supported in default-server: No
14708
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014709no-verifyhost
14710 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14711 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14712 default value.
14713 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14714 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014715
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014716no-tfo
14717 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14718 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14719 default value.
14720 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14721 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14722
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014723non-stick
14724 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14725 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14726 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14727
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014728npn <protocols>
14729 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14730 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14731 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014732 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014733 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14734 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14735 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014737observe <mode>
14738 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14739 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14740 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14741 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14742 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14743 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014744 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014745
14746 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014748on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014749 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14750 Currently, four modes are available:
14751 - fastinter: force fastinter
14752 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14753 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14754 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14755 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14756
14757 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14758
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014759on-marked-down <action>
14760 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14761 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014762 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14763 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14764 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14765 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14766 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14767 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14768 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14769 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014770
14771 Actions are disabled by default
14772
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014773on-marked-up <action>
14774 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14775 Currently one action is available:
14776 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14777 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14778 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14779 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014780 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14781 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014782 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14783 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14784
14785 Actions are disabled by default
14786
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014787pool-low-conn <max>
14788 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14789 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14790 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14791 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14792 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14793 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14794 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14795 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14796 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14797 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014798 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14799 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14800 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14801 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014802
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014803pool-max-conn <max>
14804 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14805 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14806 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14807 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14808 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14809 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14810
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014811pool-purge-delay <delay>
14812 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014813 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014814 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014816port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014817 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014818 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14819 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14820 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14821 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14822 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014823
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014824proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014825 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14826 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14827 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014828 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14829 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14830
14831 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14832 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14833 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14834 also reported (flag=HTX).
14835
14836 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14837 a server line :
14838
14839 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14840 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14841 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14842 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14843
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014844 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014845 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14846
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014847 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014849redir <prefix>
14850 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14851 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14852 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14853 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14854 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14855 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14856 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14857 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014858 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014859 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014860 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14861 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14862 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14863 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14864
14865 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014867rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014868 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14869 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14870 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14871
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014872resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14873 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14874 server.
14875
14876 Available options:
14877
14878 * allow-dup-ip
14879 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14880 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14881 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14882 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14883 For such case, simply enable this option.
14884 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14885
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014886 * ignore-weight
14887 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14888 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14889 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14890
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014891 * prevent-dup-ip
14892 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14893 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14894 same fqdn.
14895 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14896
14897 Example:
14898 backend b_myapp
14899 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14900 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14901 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14902
14903 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14904 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14905 it
14906 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14907 different address
14908
14909 Default value: not set
14910
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014911resolve-prefer <family>
14912 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14913 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14914 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14915 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14916
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014917 Default value: ipv6
14918
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014919 Example:
14920
14921 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014922
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014923resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014924 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014925 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014926 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014927 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14928 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014929 configured network, another address is selected.
14930
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014931 Example:
14932
14933 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014934
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014935resolvers <id>
14936 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14937 hostname.
14938
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014939 Example:
14940
14941 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014942
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014943 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014944
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014945send-proxy
14946 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14947 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14948 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14949 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014950 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14951 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14952 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14953 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014954 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014955 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14956 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14957 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14958 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14959 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014960 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14961 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014962
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014963send-proxy-v2
14964 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14965 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14966 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14967 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014968 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14969 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14970 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14971 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014972
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014973proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014974 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14975 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14976
14977 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14978 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14979 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14980 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14981 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14982 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14983 connection is supported).
14984 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14985 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14986 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14987 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14988 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14989 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14990 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014991
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014992send-proxy-v2-ssl
14993 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14994 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14995 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14996 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14997 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14998 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14999 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015000 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15001 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015002
15003send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15004 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15005 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15006 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15007 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15008 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15009 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15010 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15011 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015012 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15013 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015015slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015016 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15017 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15018 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15019 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15020 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15021 parameters :
15022
15023 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15024 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15025
15026 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15027 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15028 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15029 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15030
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015031 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015032 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15033 seen as failed.
15034
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015035sni <expression>
15036 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15037 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15038 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015039 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15040 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15041 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15042 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015043 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015044 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015045 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15046 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015047
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015048source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015049source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015050source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015051 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15052 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15053 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15054 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15055
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015056 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15057 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15058 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15059 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15060 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15061 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15062 server.
15063
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015064 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15065 specifying the source address without port(s).
15066
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015067ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015068 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15069 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15070 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15071 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15072 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15073 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015074 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15075 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015076
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015077ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15078 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15079 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15080 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15081
15082ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15083 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15084 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15085 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15086
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015087ssl-reuse
15088 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15089 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15090 default value.
15091 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15092 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15093
15094stick
15095 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15096 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15097 default value.
15098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15099 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015100
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015101socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015102 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015103 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15104 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15105
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015106tcp-ut <delay>
15107 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015108 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015109 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015110 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015111 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15112 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15113 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15114 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15115 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15116 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15117 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15118 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15119 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15120
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015121tfo
15122 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15123 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15124 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15125 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015126 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015127 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015129track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015130 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15131 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15132 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15133 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015134 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15135
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015136tls-tickets
15137 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15138 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15139 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015140 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15141 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15142 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015143 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015144 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015145
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015146verify [none|required]
15147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015148 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015149 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15150 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015151 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015152 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15153 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15154 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15155 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15156 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15157 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15158 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15159 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015160
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015161verifyhost <hostname>
15162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015163 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15164 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15165 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15166 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15167 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15168 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15169 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15170 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015172weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015173 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15174 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15175 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015176 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15177 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15178 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15179 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15180 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15181 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015182
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015183ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15184 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15185 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15186 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15187
15188 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15189 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15190 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15191 server ALPN contains it.
15192
15193 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15194 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15195 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15196 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15197
15198 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15199 favor of the ALPN extension.
15200
15201 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015203
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152045.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15205-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015207HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15208using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015209configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15211can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15212workload.
15213This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15214resolution at run time.
15215Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15216carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15217
15218
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152195.3.1. Global overview
15220----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015221
15222As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15223different steps of the process life:
15224
15225 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15226 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15227 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15228
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015229 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15230 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015231
15232A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15233 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15234 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15235 resolution to know this new IP.
15236
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015237When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015238HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015239SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15240from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015241will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015242will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015243
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015244A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015245 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015246 first valid response.
15247
15248 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15249 servers return an error.
15250
15251
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152525.3.2. The resolvers section
15253----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015254
15255This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015256HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15257contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015258
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015259When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15260uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15261is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15262answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15263
15264When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015265used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015266
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015267 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15268 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15269 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015270
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015271 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15272 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015273
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015274 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015275 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15276 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015277
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015278For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15279following scenarios are possible:
15280
15281 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15282 ignored
15283
15284 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15285 applied
15286
15287 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15288 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15289
15290 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15291 retries the query with a new type
15292
15293 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15294 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015295
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015296As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015297a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015298<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015299
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015300
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015301resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015302 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015303
15304A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15305
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015306accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015307 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015308 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015309 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15310 by RFC 6891)
15311
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015312 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15313 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15314 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15315 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15316 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15317 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015318
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015319nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15320 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15321 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15322 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15323 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15324 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15325 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15326 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15327 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15328 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015329 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15330
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015331parse-resolv-conf
15332 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15333 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15334 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15335
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015336hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015337 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15338 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15339 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15340 counteract the just received invalid status.
15341
15342 <status> : last name resolution status.
15343 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15344 status during the concluding period.
15345
15346 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15347 status during the concluding period.
15348
15349 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15350 valid status during the concluding period.
15351
15352 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15353 valid status during the concluding period.
15354
15355 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15356 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15357 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15358 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15359 dynamic resolution of servers.
15360
15361 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15362 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15363 applies to SRV records.
15364
15365 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15366 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15367 milliseconds by default.
15368
15369 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15370 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15371 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15372 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15373 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15374
15375 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15376 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15377 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15378 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15379
15380 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15381 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015382
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015383 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015384
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015385resolve_retries <nb>
15386 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15387 giving up.
15388 Default value: 3
15389
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015390 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15391 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15392 type.
15393
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015394timeout <event> <time>
15395 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15396 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15397 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015398 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15399 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015400 Default value: 1s
15401 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015402 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015403 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015404 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15405 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15406
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015407 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015408
15409 resolvers mydns
15410 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15411 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015412 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015413 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015414 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015415 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015416 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015417 hold other 30s
15418 hold refused 30s
15419 hold nx 30s
15420 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015421 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015422 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015423
15424
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154256. Cache
15426---------
15427
15428HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15429(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15430RAM.
15431
15432The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15433this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15434
15435If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15436independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15437when we try to allocate a new one.
15438
15439The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15440
15441It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15442"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15443for more details.
15444
15445When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15446replaced by "<CACHE>".
15447
15448
154496.1. Limitation
15450----------------
15451
15452The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15453
15454- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015455- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15456 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15457 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015458- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15459- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015460- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15461 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15462 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015463- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15464 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015465- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15466 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15467 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015468
15469- If the request is not a GET
15470- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15471- If the request contains an Authorization header
15472
15473
154746.2. Setup
15475-----------
15476
15477To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15478the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15479
15480
154816.2.1. Cache section
15482---------------------
15483
15484cache <name>
15485 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15486 size of cache is mandatory.
15487
15488total-max-size <megabytes>
15489 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15490 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15491
15492max-object-size <bytes>
15493 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15494 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15495 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15496
15497max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015498 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015499 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15500 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15501 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15502 default.
15503
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015504process-vary <on/off>
15505 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015506 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15507 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15508 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015509 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015510
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015511max-secondary-entries <number>
15512 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15513 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15514 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15515
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015516
155176.2.2. Proxy section
15518---------------------
15519
15520http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15521 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15522 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15523 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15524 after this one.
15525
15526http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15527 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15528 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15529 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15530 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15531
15532
15533Example:
15534
15535 backend bck1
15536 mode http
15537
15538 http-request cache-use foobar
15539 http-response cache-store foobar
15540 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15541
15542 cache foobar
15543 total-max-size 4
15544 max-age 240
15545
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15548----------------------------------
15549
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015550HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15552The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15553these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15554but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15555data called patterns.
15556
15557
155587.1. ACL basics
15559---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015560
15561The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15562content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15563from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15564simple :
15565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015567 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15569 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15572adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015573
15574In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015577
15578This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15579Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15580and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015581an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15582conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15583as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15584are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015585
15586ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15587'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15588which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15589
15590There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15591performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15594specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15595this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015596methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15597ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598
15599Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15600 - boolean
15601 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15602 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15603 - string
15604 - data block
15605
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015606Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15607converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15608would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15609The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15610which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15611
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015612Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15613keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15614fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15615which are summarized in the table below :
15616
15617 +---------------------+-----------------+
15618 | Sample or converter | Default |
15619 | output type | matching method |
15620 +---------------------+-----------------+
15621 | boolean | bool |
15622 +---------------------+-----------------+
15623 | integer | int |
15624 +---------------------+-----------------+
15625 | ip | ip |
15626 +---------------------+-----------------+
15627 | string | str |
15628 +---------------------+-----------------+
15629 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15630 +---------------------+-----------------+
15631
15632Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15633matching method, see below.
15634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15636 - boolean
15637 - integer or integer range
15638 - IP address / network
15639 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15640 - regular expression
15641 - hex block
15642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015643The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15644
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015645 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15646 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015648 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015649 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015650 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015651 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15654read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15655if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15656lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15657will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15658beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015659a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15661exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15662
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015663The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15664parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15665ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15666a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15667check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15668
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015669The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15670socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15671file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15674loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15675
15676 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15677
15678In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15679the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15680case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15681as well.
15682
15683The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15684sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15685do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15686methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15687is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015688obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15690default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15691that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15692string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15693
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015694The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15695By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15696string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15697resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015698server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015699waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015700flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15701function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15704sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15705be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015706
15707 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15708 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15710 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15711 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15712 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015713
15714 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15715 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015717
15718 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015720
15721 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015723
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015724 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015725 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15726
15727 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15728 binary or string samples.
15729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15731 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15734 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15735 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15738 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15741 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15744 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15747 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015748 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15751 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15752 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015753
15754For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15755request, it is possible to do :
15756
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015757 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015758
15759In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15760buffer, one would use the following acl :
15761
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015762 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015763
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015764On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15765possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15766
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015767 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15770criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15771method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015772to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15773usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15774converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15775method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15776matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15778the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015781the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15782For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15785 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15786 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15787 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015788
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015789
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015790The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15791types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15792combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15793brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15794default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 +-------------------------------------------------+
15797 | Input sample type |
15798 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015799 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15801 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15802 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015803 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015805 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015807 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015809 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015811 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015813 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015815 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015817 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015819 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015821 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015823 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15825 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015827
15828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158297.1.1. Matching booleans
15830------------------------
15831
15832In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15833Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15834When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15835that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15836
15837Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15838return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15839"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158427.1.2. Matching integers
15843------------------------
15844
15845Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15846enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15847to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15848
15849Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15850matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15851lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015852
15853For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15854unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15855representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15856
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015857As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15858two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15859instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15860ranges and operators.
15861
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015862For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015863operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15864Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15865of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015867Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015868
15869 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15870 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15871 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15872 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15873 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015875For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015876
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015877 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015878
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015879This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15880
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015881 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015882
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158847.1.3. Matching strings
15885-----------------------
15886
15887String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15888different forms :
15889
15890 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892
15893 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015894 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895
15896 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15897 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15898
15899 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15900 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15901
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015902 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15903 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15904 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15905 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15906 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15907 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015909 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15910 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15911 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15912 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15913 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15914 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15915 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15916 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15917 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15918 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15919 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015920
15921String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15922exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15923characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15924string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15925to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015926before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015927
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015928Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15929(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15930Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15931
15932Example:
15933 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15934 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15938---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015939
15940Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15941they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15942possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15943passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15944the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015945the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15946match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015947
15948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15950-------------------------------------
15951
15952It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15953not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15954a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15955to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15956digits may be used upper or lower case.
15957
15958Example :
15959 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015960 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961
15962
159637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15964---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015965
15966IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15967netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15968within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015969host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015970difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15971at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15972does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15973parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015974
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015975The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15976abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15977
15978 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15979 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15980 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15981 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15982 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15983 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15984 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15985 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15986
15987Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15988192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15989
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015990IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15991Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15992trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15993IPv6 patterns.
15994
15995HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15996following situations :
15997 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15998 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15999 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16000 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16001 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16002 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16003 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16004 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16005 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16006 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008
160097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16010----------------------------------
16011
16012Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16013combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16014
16015 - AND (implicit)
16016 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16017 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16024indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16027"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16028requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16029is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16030
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016031 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016032 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16033 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16034 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035
16036To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16037and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16038
16039 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16040 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16041 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16042 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016044 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16046 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16047 use_backend www if host_www
16048
16049It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16050expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16051be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16052the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16053
16054 The following rule :
16055
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016056 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016057 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058
16059 Can also be written that way :
16060
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016061 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062
16063It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16064to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16065simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16066sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16067good use is the following :
16068
16069 With named ACLs :
16070
16071 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16072 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16073 monitor fail if site_dead
16074
16075 With anonymous ACLs :
16076
16077 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16078
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016079See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16080keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081
16082
160837.3. Fetching samples
16084---------------------
16085
16086Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16087against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16088sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16089ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16090of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16091available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16092
16093This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16094Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16095compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16096deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16097
16098The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16099matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16100method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16101indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16102
16103As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16104when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16105mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16106the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16107ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16108
16109Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16110multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16111when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16113are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16115all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16116
16117Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16118 - name
16119 - name(arg1)
16120 - name(arg1,arg2)
16121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016122
161237.3.1. Converters
16124-----------------
16125
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016126Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16127of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16128is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16129was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016130has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016131unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16132
16133These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16134sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16135the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016136support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016137
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016138A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16139support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16140supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16141(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16142bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016145
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001614651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16147 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16148 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16149 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16150 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16151 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16152
16153 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016154 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16155 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016156 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16157 frontend http-in
16158 bind *:8081
16159 default_backend servers
16160 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16161 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16162
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016163add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016164 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016165 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016166 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16167 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016168 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016169 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16170 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16171 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16172 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016174 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016175
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016176aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16177 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16178 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16179 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16180 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16181 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16182 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16183
16184 Example:
16185 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16186 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16187
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016188and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016189 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016190 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016191 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16192 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16195 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16196 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16197 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016199 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016200
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016201b64dec
16202 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16203 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016204 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16205 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016206
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016207base64
16208 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016209 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016210 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16211 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016212
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016213bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016214 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016215 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016216 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016217 presence of a flag).
16218
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016219bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16220 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16221 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016222 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016223
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016224concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16225 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16226 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16227 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16228 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16229 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16230 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16231 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16232 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16233 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16234 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016235 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016236 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016237 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16238 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016239
16240 Example:
16241 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16242 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16243 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016244 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016245 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16246
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016247cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016248 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16249 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016250
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016251crc32([<avalanche>])
16252 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16253 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16254 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16255 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16256 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16257 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16258 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16259 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16260 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16261 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016262 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16263
16264crc32c([<avalanche>])
16265 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16266 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16267 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16268 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16269 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16270 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16271 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16272 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016273
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016274cut_crlf
16275 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16276 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16277 updated.
16278
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016279da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016280 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16281 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16282 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16283 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016284 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016285 configuration language.
16286
16287 Example:
16288 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016289 bind *:8881
16290 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016291 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016292
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016293debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16294 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16295 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16296 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16297 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16298 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16299 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16300 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16301 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16302 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16303 printable sample types.
16304
16305 Example:
16306 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016307
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016308digest(<algorithm>)
16309 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16310 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16311
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016312 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016313 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16314
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016315div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016316 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16317 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016318 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016319 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16320 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016321 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016322 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16323 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16324 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16325 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016327 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016328
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016329djb2([<avalanche>])
16330 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16331 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16332 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16333 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16334 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16335 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16336 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016337 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16338 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016339
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016340even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016341 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016342 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16343
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016344field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16345 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16346 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16347 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16348 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16349 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16350 fields.
16351
16352 Example :
16353 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16354 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16355 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16356 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16357 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016358
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016359fix_is_valid
16360 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16361 Information eXchange):
16362
16363 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16364 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016365 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016366 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016367 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016368 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16369 checksum
16370
16371 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16372 the server can be parsed.
16373
16374 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16375 message, false if not.
16376
16377 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16378
16379 Example:
16380 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16381 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16382
16383fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16384 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16385 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16386 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16387 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016388 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016389 added.
16390
16391 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16392 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16393 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16394 fix_is_valid converter.
16395
16396 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16397
16398 Example:
16399 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16400 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16401 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16402 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16403 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016405hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016406 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016407 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016408 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016409 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016410
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016411hex2i
16412 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016413 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016414
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016415htonl
16416 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16417 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16418 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16419 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16420
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016421hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016422 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16423 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16424 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16425 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16426
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016427 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016428 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16429
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016430http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016431 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16432 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016433 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16434 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16435 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16436 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16437 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16438 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16439 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16440 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016442iif(<true>,<false>)
16443 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16444 string otherwise.
16445
16446 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016447 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016448
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016449in_table(<table>)
16450 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16451 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16452 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016454 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16455
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016456ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016457 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016458 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016459 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16460 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16461 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16462 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16463 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016464
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016465json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016466 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016467 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016468 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016469 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16470 of errors:
16471 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16472 bytes, ...)
16473 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16474 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16475
16476 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16477 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16478 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16479 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16480 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16481 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016482 - "ascii" : never fails;
16483 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16484 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016485 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016486 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016487 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16488 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16489
16490 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016491 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016492
16493 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016494 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016495 capture request header user-agent len 150
16496 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016497
16498 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16499 GET / HTTP/1.0
16500 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16501
16502 Output log:
16503 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16504
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016505json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16506 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16507 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16508 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16509 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16510
16511 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16512 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16513
16514 Example:
16515 # get a integer value from the request body
16516 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16517 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16518
16519 # get a key with '.' in the name
16520 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16521 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16522
16523 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16524 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16525
16526 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16527 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16528
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016529language(<value>[,<default>])
16530 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16531 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16532 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16533 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16534 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16535 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16536 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16537 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16538 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016539 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016540 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16541 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016543 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016544
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016545 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16546 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016548 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16549 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16550 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16551 use_backend spanish if es
16552 use_backend french if fr
16553 use_backend english if en
16554 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016555
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016556length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016557 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16558 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16559 type. The result is of type integer.
16560
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016561lower
16562 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16563 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16564 type. The result is of type string.
16565
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016566ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16567 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16568 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16569 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16570 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16571 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16572 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16573
16574 Example :
16575
16576 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016578 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16579
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016580ltrim(<chars>)
16581 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16582 representation of the input sample.
16583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016584map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16585map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16586map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16587 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16588 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16589 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16590 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16591 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16592 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16593 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16594 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016595
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016596 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16597 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16598 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016599
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016600 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016601 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016602
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016603 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16605 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016607 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016609 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16611 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16613 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16614 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16615 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16616 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016617 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16619 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16621 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16622 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16623 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016625
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016626 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16627 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16628 the corresponding match text.
16629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016630 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16631 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16632 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16633 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16634 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016635
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016636 Example :
16637
16638 # this is a comment and is ignored
16639 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16640 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16641 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16642 | | | `---------- value
16643 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16644 | `---------------------------- key
16645 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16646
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016647mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016648 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16649 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016650 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016651 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016652 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016653 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16654 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016658 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016659
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016660mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016661 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16662 <packettype>.
16663 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16664 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16665 from.
16666 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16667 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16668 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16669
16670 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16671 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16672 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16673 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16674
16675 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16676 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16677 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16678 packets only):
16679 17: Session Expiry Interval
16680 33: Receive Maximum
16681 39: Maximum Packet Size
16682 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16683 25: Request Response Information
16684 23: Request Problem Information
16685 21: Authentication Method
16686 22: Authentication Data
16687 18: Will Delay Interval
16688 1: Payload Format Indicator
16689 2: Message Expiry Interval
16690 3: Content Type
16691 8: Response Topic
16692 9: Correlation Data
16693 Not supported yet:
16694 38: User Property
16695
16696 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16697 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16698 packets only):
16699 17: Session Expiry Interval
16700 33: Receive Maximum
16701 36: Maximum QoS
16702 37: Retain Available
16703 39: Maximum Packet Size
16704 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16705 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16706 31: Reason String
16707 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16708 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16709 42: Shared Subscription Available
16710 19: Server Keep Alive
16711 26: Response Information
16712 28: Server Reference
16713 21: Authentication Method
16714 22: Authentication Data
16715 Not supported yet:
16716 38: User Property
16717
16718 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16719 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16720 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16721 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16722
16723 Example:
16724
16725 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16726 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16727 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16728 if data_in_buffer
16729 # do the same as above
16730 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16731 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16732 if data_in_buffer
16733
16734mqtt_is_valid
16735 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16736
16737 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16738 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16739 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16740 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16741
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016742 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16743
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016744 Example:
16745
16746 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016747 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016748
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016749mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016750 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016751 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16752 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016753 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016754 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016755 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016756 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16757 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16758 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16759 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016761 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016762
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016763nbsrv
16764 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16765 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16766 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16767 map lookup.
16768
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016769neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016770 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16771 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16772 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16773 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016774
16775not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016776 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016777 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016778 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016779 absence of a flag).
16780
16781odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016782 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016783 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16784
16785or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016786 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016787 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016788 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16789 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016790 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016791 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16792 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16793 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16794 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016795 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016796 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016797
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016798protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16799 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16800 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16801 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16802 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16803 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16804 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16805 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16806 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16807 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16808 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16809 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16810
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016811regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016812 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16813 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16814 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16815 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16816 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16817 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16818 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16819 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16820 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016821 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16822 of characters with other ones.
16823
16824 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16825 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16826 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16827 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16828 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16829 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016830
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016831 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016832
16833 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16834 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16835 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016836 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016837
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016838 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16839 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16840
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016841 # capture groups and backreferences
16842 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016843 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016844 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16845
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016846capture-req(<id>)
16847 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16848 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16849
16850 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016851 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16852 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016853
16854capture-res(<id>)
16855 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16856 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16857
16858 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016859 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16860 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016861
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016862rtrim(<chars>)
16863 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16864 of the input sample.
16865
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016866sdbm([<avalanche>])
16867 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16868 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16869 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16870 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16871 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16872 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16873 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016874 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16875 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016876
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016877secure_memcmp(<var>)
16878 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16879 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16880 match.
16881
16882 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16883 performed in constant time.
16884
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016885 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016886 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16887
16888 Example :
16889
16890 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16891 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16892 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16893 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16894
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016895set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016896 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16897 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16898 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016899 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16901 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016902 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016907
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016908sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016909 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016910 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16911
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016912sha2([<bits>])
16913 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16914 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16915
16916 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16917 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16918
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016919 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016920 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16921
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016922srv_queue
16923 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16924 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16925 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16926 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16927 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16928
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016929strcmp(<var>)
16930 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16931 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16932 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16933 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16934 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16935 shorter).
16936
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016937 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16938 strings in constant time.
16939
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016940 Example :
16941
16942 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16943 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16944 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16945
16946
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016947sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016948 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16949 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016950 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016951 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16952 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016953 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016954 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16955 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016956 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016957 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16958 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016959 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016960 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016961
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016962table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16965 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16966 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16967 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16968 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16969
16970
16971table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16975 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16976 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16977 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16978
16979table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16980 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16981 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016982 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016983 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16984 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16985
16986table_conn_cur(<table>)
16987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16990 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16991 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16992
16993table_conn_rate(<table>)
16994 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16995 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16996 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16997 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16998 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16999
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017000table_gpt0(<table>)
17001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17004 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17005 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17006
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017007table_gpc0(<table>)
17008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17011 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17012 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17013
17014table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17018 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17019 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17020 sample fetch keyword.
17021
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017022table_gpc1(<table>)
17023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17026 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17027 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17028
17029table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17033 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17034 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17035 sample fetch keyword.
17036
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017037table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17038 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17039 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017040 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017041 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17042 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17043
17044table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17045 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17046 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17047 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17048 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17049 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17050 keyword.
17051
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017052table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17053 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17054 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17055 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17056 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17057 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17058
17059table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17060 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17061 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17062 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17063 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17064 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17065 keyword.
17066
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017067table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17068 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17069 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017070 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017071 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17072 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17073
17074table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17077 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17078 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17079 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17080 keyword.
17081
17082table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17083 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17084 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017085 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017086 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17087 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17088 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17089 keyword.
17090
17091table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017095 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17096 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17097 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17098 keyword.
17099
17100table_server_id(<table>)
17101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17104 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17105 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17106 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17107
17108table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017112 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17113 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17114 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17115 keyword.
17116
17117table_sess_rate(<table>)
17118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17121 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17122 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17123 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17124 keyword.
17125
17126table_trackers(<table>)
17127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17130 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17131 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17132 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17133 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17134 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17135 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17136 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17137
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017138ub64dec
17139 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17140 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17141 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17142
17143 Example:
17144 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17145 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17146
17147ub64enc
17148 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17149
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017150upper
17151 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17152 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17153 type. The result is of type string.
17154
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017155url_dec([<in_form>])
17156 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17157 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17158 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17159 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17160 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17161 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017162
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017163url_enc([<enc_type>])
17164 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17165 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17166 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17167 optional argument is here for future changes.
17168
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017169ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017170 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017171 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17172 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17173 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017174 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17175 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17176 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17177 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017178 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017179 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17180 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017181
17182 Example:
17183 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17184 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17185
17186 message Point {
17187 int32 latitude = 1;
17188 int32 longitude = 2;
17189 }
17190
17191 message PPoint {
17192 Point point = 59;
17193 }
17194
17195 message Rectangle {
17196 // One corner of the rectangle.
17197 PPoint lo = 48;
17198 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17199 PPoint hi = 49;
17200 }
17201
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017202 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17203 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17204 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017205
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017206 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17207 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017208 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017209 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17210
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017211 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017212
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017213 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017214
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017215 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17216 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17217 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017218
17219 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17220 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17221 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17222
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017223 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17224 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17225 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017226
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017227
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017228unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017229 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17230 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17234 response),
17235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17238 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17239
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017240utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17241 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17242 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17243 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17244 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17245 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17246 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17247
17248 Example :
17249
17250 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017251 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017252 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17253
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017254word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17255 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17256 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17257 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017258 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017259 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17260 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17261
17262 Example :
17263 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17267 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017268 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017269
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017270wt6([<avalanche>])
17271 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17272 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17273 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17274 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17275 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17276 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17277 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017278 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17279 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017280
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017281xor(<value>)
17282 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017283 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017284 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017285 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017289 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017290 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17291 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017292 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017293 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017294
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017295xxh3([<seed>])
17296 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17297 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17298 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17299 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17300 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17301 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17302 considered as cryptographically secure.
17303
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017304xxh32([<seed>])
17305 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17306 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17307 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17308 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17309 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17310 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17311 as cryptographically secure.
17312
17313xxh64([<seed>])
17314 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17315 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17316 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17317 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17318 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17319 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17320 as cryptographically secure.
17321
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017322
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173237.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017324--------------------------------------------
17325
17326A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17327not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17328"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17329The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17330
17331always_false : boolean
17332 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17333 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17334
17335always_true : boolean
17336 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17337 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17338
17339avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017340 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17342 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17343 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17344 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17345 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17346 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17347 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17348 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17349 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17350 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17351 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17352 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17353 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017356 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17357 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17358 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17359 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017360 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17361
17362be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17363 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17364 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17365 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17366 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17367 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017368 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17369 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017370
17371 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17372 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17373 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17376 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17377 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17378 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017379 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017380 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17381 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017382
17383 Example :
17384 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17385 backend dynamic
17386 mode http
17387 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17388 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017389
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017390bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017391 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17392 of the string.
17393
17394bool(<bool>) : bool
17395 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17396 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017400 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17402 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017403
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017404 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017405 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017406 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17407
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017408 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17409 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017410
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017411 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017412 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017414 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017415 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017417 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017418
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017419 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17420 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017422 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017423
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017424cpu_calls : integer
17425 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17426 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17427 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17428 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17429 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17430 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17431
17432cpu_ns_avg : integer
17433 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17434 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17435 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17436 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17437 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17438 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17439 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17440 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17441 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17442 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17443 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17444
17445cpu_ns_tot : integer
17446 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17447 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17448 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17449 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17450 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17451 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17452 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17453 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17454 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17455 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17456 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17457 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17458 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17459
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017460date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017461 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017462
17463 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17464 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17465 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017466 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17467
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017468 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17469 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17470 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17471 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17472 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17473
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017474 Example :
17475
17476 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17477 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017478
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017479 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17480 # millisecond granularity
17481 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17482
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017483date_us : integer
17484 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17485 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17486 from the same timeval structure.
17487
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017488distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17489 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17490 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17491 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17492 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017493 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017494 list of supported tokens.
17495
17496distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17497 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17498 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17499 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17500 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017501 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017502 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17503 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17504 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17505 supported tokens.
17506
17507 Example :
17508 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17509 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17510 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17511 # send large files to the big farm
17512 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17513
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017514env(<name>) : string
17515 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17516 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17517 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17518 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17519 certain way.
17520
17521 Examples :
17522 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17523 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17524
17525 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017526 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17529 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017530 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17531 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17533 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17536 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017537
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017538fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17539 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17540 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17541 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017543fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17545 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17546 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17547 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17548 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17549 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17550 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17551 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017552
17553 Example :
17554 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17555 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17556 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17557 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17558 frontend mail
17559 bind :25
17560 mode tcp
17561 maxconn 100
17562 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17563 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17564 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17565 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017566
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017567hostname : string
17568 Returns the system hostname.
17569
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017570int(<integer>) : signed integer
17571 Returns a signed integer.
17572
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017573ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17574 Returns an ipv4.
17575
17576ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17577 Returns an ipv6.
17578
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017579lat_ns_avg : integer
17580 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17581 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17582 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17583 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17584 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17585 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17586 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17587 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17588 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017589 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17590 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17591 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17592 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17593 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17594 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017595
17596lat_ns_tot : integer
17597 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17598 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17599 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17600 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17601 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17602 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17603 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17604 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17605 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017606 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17607 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17608 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17609 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17610 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017611 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17612 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17613 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17614 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17615 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17616 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17617
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017618meth(<method>) : method
17619 Returns a method.
17620
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017621nbproc : integer
17622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17623 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17624 and debugging purposes.
17625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017626nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17627 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17628 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17629 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017630 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17631 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17632 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017633
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017634prio_class : integer
17635 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17636 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17637 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17638
17639prio_offset : integer
17640 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17641 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17642 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17643 set-priority-offset".
17644
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017645proc : integer
17646 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17647 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17648 debugging purposes.
17649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017651 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17652 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17653 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017654 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17655 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17656 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17657 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17658 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17659
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017660rand([<range>]) : integer
17661 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17662 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17663 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17664 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17665 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17669 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17670 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17671 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17672 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017673 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17674 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17675
17676srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17678 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17679 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17680 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17681 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17682 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17683 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17684
17685 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17686 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687
17688srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17689 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17690 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17691 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017692 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017693 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17694 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17695 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17696
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017697srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17698 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17699 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17700 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17701 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17702 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17703 fetch methods.
17704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17706 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17707 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017708 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017709 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17710 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017711 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712 overloading servers).
17713
17714 Example :
17715 # Redirect to a separate back
17716 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17717 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17718 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17719
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017720srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017721 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17722 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17723 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17724
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017725srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017726 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17727 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17728 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17729
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017730srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017731 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17732 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17733 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17734
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017735stopping : boolean
17736 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17737 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17738 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17739
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017740str(<string>) : string
17741 Returns a string.
17742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17744 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17745 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17746
17747table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17748 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17749 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17750 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17751
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017752thread : integer
17753 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17754 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17755 and debugging purposes.
17756
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017757uuid([<version>]) : string
17758 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17759 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17760 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17761
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017762var(<var-name>) : undefined
17763 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017764 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17765 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017766 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017767 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17768 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017769 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017770 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17771 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017772 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017773 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017774
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177757.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017776----------------------------------
17777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017778The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17780methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17781sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17782TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017783the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17784counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017785"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17786used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17787can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17788Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17789table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17790tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17791currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017792
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017793bc_dst : ip
17794 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17795 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17796 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17797 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17798
17799bc_dst_port : integer
17800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017801 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017802
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017803bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017804 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17805 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17806 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17807
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017808bc_src : ip
17809 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017810 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017811 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17812 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17813
17814bc_src_port : integer
17815 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017816 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017818be_id : integer
17819 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017820 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17821 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017823be_name : string
17824 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017825 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17826 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017827
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017828be_server_timeout : integer
17829 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17830 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17831 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17832
17833be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17834 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17835 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17836 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17837
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017838cur_server_timeout : integer
17839 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17840 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17841 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17842
17843cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17844 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17845 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17846 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848dst : ip
17849 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17850 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17851 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17852 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017853 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17854 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17855 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17856 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17857 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17858 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859
17860dst_conn : integer
17861 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17862 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17863 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17864 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17865 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17866 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17867 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17868 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017869
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017870dst_is_local : boolean
17871 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17872 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17873 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17874 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017875 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017876 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17877 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17878 it only once per connection.
17879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880dst_port : integer
17881 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17882 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17883 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17884 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17885 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17886 an HTTP header.
17887
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017888fc_fackets : integer
17889 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17890 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17891 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17892 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17893
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017894fc_http_major : integer
17895 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17896 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17897 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17898
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017899fc_lost : integer
17900 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17901 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17902 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17903 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17904
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017905fc_pp_authority : string
17906 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17907 if any.
17908
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017909fc_pp_unique_id : string
17910 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17911 if any.
17912
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017913fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17914 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17915 header.
17916
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017917fc_reordering : integer
17918 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17919 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17920 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17921 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17922
17923fc_retrans : integer
17924 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17925 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17926 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17927 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17928
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017929fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17930 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17931 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17932 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17933 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17934 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17935 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17936
17937fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17938 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17939 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17940 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17941 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17942 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17943 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17944
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017945fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017946 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17947 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17948 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17949 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17950
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017951
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017952fc_unacked : integer
17953 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17954 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17955 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17956 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017957
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017958fe_defbe : string
17959 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17960 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962fe_id : integer
17963 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017964 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17966
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017967fe_name : string
17968 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17969 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17970 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17971
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017972fe_client_timeout : integer
17973 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17974 current frontend.
17975
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017976sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017977sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17978sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17979sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017980 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17981 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17982 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17983
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017984sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017985sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17986sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17987sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017988 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17989 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17990 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17991
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017992sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017993sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17994sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17995sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017996 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17997 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017998 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17999 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18000 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018001
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018002 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018003 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18004 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018005 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18006 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18007 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018008 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18009 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18010
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018011sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18012sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18013sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18014sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18015 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18016 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18017 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18018 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18019 when a first ACL was verified.
18020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018021sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018022sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18023sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18024sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018025 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018026 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018028sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018029sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18030sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18031sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018032 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18033 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18034 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018036sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018037sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18039sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018040 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18041 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18042 See also src_conn_rate.
18043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018044sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018045sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18046sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18047sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018048 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018049 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018050
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018051sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18052sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18053sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18054sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18055 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18056 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18057
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018058sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18059sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18060sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18061sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18062 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18063 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018065sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018066sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18067sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18068sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018069 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18070 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18071 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018072 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18073 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18074 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018075
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018076sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18077sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18078sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18079sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18080 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18081 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18082 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18083 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18084 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18085 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18086
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018087sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018088sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18089sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18090sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018091 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018092 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18093 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018095sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018096sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18097sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18098sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018099 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18100 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18101 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18102 src_http_err_rate.
18103
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018104sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18105sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18106sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18107sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18108 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18109 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18110 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18111
18112sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18113sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18114sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18115sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18116 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18117 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18118 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18119 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018121sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018122sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18123sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18124sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018125 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018126 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18127 src_http_req_cnt.
18128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018129sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018130sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18131sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18132sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018133 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18134 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18135 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18136 src_http_req_rate.
18137
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018138sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018139sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18140sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18141sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018142 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018143 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18144 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18145 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18146 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018147
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018148 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018149 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18150 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018151 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18152
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018153sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18154sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18155sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18156sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18157 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18158 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18159 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18160 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18161 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018163sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018164sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18165sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18166sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018167 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18168 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18169 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018170
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018171sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018172sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18173sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18174sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018175 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18176 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18177 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018179sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018180sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18181sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18182sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018183 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018184 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18185 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18186 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018187 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018188 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018190sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018191sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18192sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18193sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018194 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18195 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18196 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18197 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18198 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018199 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018201sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018202sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18203sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18204sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018205 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18206 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18207 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018209sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018210sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18211sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18212sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018213 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18214 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018215 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018216 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18217 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18219 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18220 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222so_id : integer
18223 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18224 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18225 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018226
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018227so_name : string
18228 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18229 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18230 strings instead of integers.
18231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018232src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018233 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18235 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18236 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018237 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18238 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18239 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018240 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18241 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18242 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18243 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18244 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18245 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18246 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018247
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018248 Example:
18249 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18250 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18253 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18254 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18255 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018256 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018258src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18259 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18260 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018261 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018262 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18265 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18266 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18267 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18268 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18269 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18270 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018271
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018272 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018273 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18274 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18275 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18276 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018277 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018278 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18279 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18280
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018281src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18282 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18283 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18284 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18285 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18286 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18287 was verified.
18288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018290 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018292 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018293 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018296 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018297 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18298 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018299 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18302 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18303 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18304 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018305 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018308 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018310 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018311 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018312
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018313src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18314 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18315 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18316 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18317 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18318
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018319src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18320 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18321 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18322 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18323 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018326 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018328 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18329 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018330 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18331 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18332 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018333
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018334src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18335 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18336 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18337 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18338 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18339 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18340 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18341 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018344 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018346 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018347 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18351 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18352 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18353 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18354 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018355 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018356
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018357src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18358 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18359 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018360 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018361 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18362 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18363
18364src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18365 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18366 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18367 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18368 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18369 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18370 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018373 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18375 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018376 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18379 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18380 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18381 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018382 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018383 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018385src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18386 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18387 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18388 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018389 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18391 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018392
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018393 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018394 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018395 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018396 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018397
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018398src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18399 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18400 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18401 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18402 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18403 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18404 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18405
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018406src_is_local : boolean
18407 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18408 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18409 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18410 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018411 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018412 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18413 once per connection.
18414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018416 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18417 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18418 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18419 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18420 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018423 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18424 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18425 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18426 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18427 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018429src_port : integer
18430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18431 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18432 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18433 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018435src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018436 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018437 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18438 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18439 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018440 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018442src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18443 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18444 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18445 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18446 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018447 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018449src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18450 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18451 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18452 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18453 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18454 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18455 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18456 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18457 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018458
18459 Example :
18460 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18461 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18462 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18463 listen ssh
18464 bind :22
18465 mode tcp
18466 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018467 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018468 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018469 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018471srv_id : integer
18472 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18473 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018474 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018475
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018476srv_name : string
18477 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18478 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018479 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018480
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018484The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018485closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18486when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18487usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018488future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018489
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001849051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18491 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18492 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18493 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18494 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18495 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18496
18497 Example :
18498 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18499 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18500 # the request.
18501 frontend http-in
18502 bind *:8081
18503 default_backend servers
18504 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18505 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18506
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018507ssl_bc : boolean
18508 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18509 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018510 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018511 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018512
18513ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18514 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018515 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18516 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018517
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018518ssl_bc_alpn : string
18519 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18520 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018521 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018522 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18523 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18524 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18525 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18526 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018527 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18528 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018529
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018530ssl_bc_cipher : string
18531 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018532 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18533 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018534
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018535ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18536 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18537 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18538 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018539 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018540
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018541ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18542 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18543 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018544 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18545 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018546
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018547ssl_bc_npn : string
18548 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18549 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018550 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018551 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18552 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18553 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18554 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018555 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18556 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018557
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018558ssl_bc_protocol : string
18559 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018560 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18561 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018562
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018563ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018564 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018565 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018566 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18567 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018568
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018569ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18570 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18571 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18572 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018573 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018574
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018575ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18576 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18577 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018578 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18579 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018580
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018581ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18582 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18583 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18584 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018585 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018586
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018587ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18588 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018589 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18590 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18593 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18594 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18595 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18596 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18597 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18600 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18601 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18602 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18603 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018604
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018605ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018606 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18607 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18608 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018609 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018610 does not support resumed sessions.
18611
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018612ssl_c_der : binary
18613 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18614 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18615 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617ssl_c_err : integer
18618 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18619 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18620 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18621 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18622 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018623
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018624ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18626 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18627 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18628 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18629 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18630 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18631 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18632 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018633 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18634 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18635 LDAP v3.
18636 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18637 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018639ssl_c_key_alg : string
18640 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18641 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18642 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644ssl_c_notafter : string
18645 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18646 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18647 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649ssl_c_notbefore : string
18650 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18651 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18652 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018653
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018654ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18656 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18657 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18658 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18659 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18660 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18661 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18662 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018663 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18664 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18665 LDAP v3.
18666 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18667 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018669ssl_c_serial : binary
18670 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18671 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18672 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018674ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18675 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18676 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18677 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018678 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18679 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18680
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018681 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018684ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18685 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18686 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18687 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689ssl_c_used : boolean
18690 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18691 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693ssl_c_verify : integer
18694 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18695 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18696 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18697 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699ssl_c_version : integer
18700 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18701 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018702
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018703ssl_f_der : binary
18704 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18705 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18706 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18707
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018708ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018709 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18710 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18711 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18712 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018713 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018714 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18715 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18716 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018717 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18718 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18719 LDAP v3.
18720 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18721 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723ssl_f_key_alg : string
18724 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18725 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18726 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728ssl_f_notafter : string
18729 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18730 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18731 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018733ssl_f_notbefore : string
18734 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18735 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18736 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018737
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018738ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018739 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18740 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18741 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18742 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18743 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18744 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18745 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18746 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018747 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18748 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18749 LDAP v3.
18750 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18751 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753ssl_f_serial : binary
18754 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18755 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18756 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018757
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018758ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18759 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18760 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18761 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018763ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18764 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18765 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18766 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768ssl_f_version : integer
18769 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18770 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18771
18772ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018773 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18774 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18775 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777 Example :
18778 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18779 listen http-https
18780 bind :80
18781 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18782 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18783
18784ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18785 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18786 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18787
18788ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018789 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018790 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018791 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018792 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18793 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18794 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18795 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18796 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18797 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799ssl_fc_cipher : string
18800 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18801 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018802
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018803ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18804 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18805 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018806 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018807
18808ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18809 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18810 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018811 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018812
18813ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18814 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18815 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18816 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018817 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018818 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018819
18820ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18821 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18822 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018823 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018824
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018825ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18826 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18827 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18828 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18829
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018830ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18831 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18832 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18833 transport layer.
18834 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18835 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18836 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18837 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18838
18839ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18840 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18841 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18842 transport layer.
18843 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18844 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18845 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18846 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18847
18848ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18849 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18850 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18851 transport layer.
18852 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18853 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18854 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18855 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18856
18857ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18858 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18859 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18860 transport layer.
18861 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18862 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18863 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18864 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18865
18866ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18867 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18868 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18869 transport layer.
18870 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18871 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18872 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18873 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018876 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18877 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018878 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18879 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18880 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18881 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018882
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018883ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18884 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18885 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18886 wait until the handshake happened.
18887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018888ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18889 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018890 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18891 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018892 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018893 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018894
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018895ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018896 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018897 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18898 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018901 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018902 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18904 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18905 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18906 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18907 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18908 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018910ssl_fc_protocol : string
18911 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18912 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018913
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018914ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018915 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018916 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018917 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018918
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018919ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18920 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18921 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18922 transport layer.
18923 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18924 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18925 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18926 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18927
18928ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18929 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18930 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18931 transport layer.
18932 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18933 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18934 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18935 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18936
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018937ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18938 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18939 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18940 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018942ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18943 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18944 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18945 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18946 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018947
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018948ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18949 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18950 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18951 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18952 BoringSSL.
18953
18954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955ssl_fc_sni : string
18956 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18957 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018958 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18960 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18961
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018962 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018963 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018965 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018966 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018967
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018968 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18969 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18970 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18971 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18972 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18973 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18974 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18975 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18976 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18980 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18983 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18984 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018985
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018986ssl_s_der : binary
18987 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18988 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18989 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18990
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018991ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18992 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18993 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18994 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018995 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018996 does not support resumed sessions.
18997
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018998ssl_s_key_alg : string
18999 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19000 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19001 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19002
19003ssl_s_notafter : string
19004 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19005 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19006 transport layer.
19007
19008ssl_s_notbefore : string
19009 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19010 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19011 transport layer.
19012
19013ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19014 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19015 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19016 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19017 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19018 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19019 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019020 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19021 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019022 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19023 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19024 LDAP v3.
19025 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19026 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19027
19028ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19029 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19030 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19031 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19032 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19033 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19034 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019035 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19036 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019037 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19038 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19039 LDAP v3.
19040 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19041 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19042
19043ssl_s_serial : binary
19044 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19045 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19046 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19047
19048ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19049 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19050 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19051 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19052
19053ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19054 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19055 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19056 layer.
19057
19058ssl_s_version : integer
19059 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19060 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019065Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19066sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19067only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19068For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19069be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19070can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19071sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19072for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19073content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019074
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019075Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19076 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019077 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019078 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19079 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19080 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19081 sample expression). So be careful.
19082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019084 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019085 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19086 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19089 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019090 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019093req.len : integer
19094req_len : integer (deprecated)
19095 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19096 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19097 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19098 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19099 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019100 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19102 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019104req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19105 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019106 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19107 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19108 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19109 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019110
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019111 ACL derivatives :
19112 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019114req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19115 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19116 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19117 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19118 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019119
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019120 ACL derivatives :
19121 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019123 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019125req.proto_http : boolean
19126req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19127 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19128 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19129 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19130 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19131 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19132 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19133 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019135 Example:
19136 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19137 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19138 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019139 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19142rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19143 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19144 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19145 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19146 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19147 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19148 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19149 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19152 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19153 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19154 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19155 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19156 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019159 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019161 Example :
19162 listen tse-farm
19163 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19164 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19165 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19166 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19167 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19168 persist rdp-cookie
19169 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19170 # This is only useful makes sense if
19171 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19172 stick-table type string size 204800
19173 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19174 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19175 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019177 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019178 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19181rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19182 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19183 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19184 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19185 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019187 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019188 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019189
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019190req.ssl_alpn : string
19191 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19192 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19193 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19194 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19195 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19196 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019197 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019198
19199 Examples :
19200 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19201 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019202 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019203 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019204 default_backend bk_default
19205
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019206req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19207 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19208 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019209 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19210 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19211 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19212 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19213 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19216req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19217 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19218 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19219 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19220 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19221 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19222 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19223 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225req.ssl_sni : string
19226req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19227 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19228 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19229 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19230 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19231 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019232 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19233 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19234 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19235 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19236 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19237 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19238 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19239 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19240 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019242 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019243 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019245 Examples :
19246 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19247 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019248 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019249 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019250 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019251
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019252req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19253 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19254 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19255 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19256 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19257 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19258 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19259 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19260 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19261 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019263req.ssl_ver : integer
19264req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19265 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19266 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19267 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19268 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19269 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19270 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19271 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019272 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019273 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019275 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019276 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019277
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019278res.len : integer
19279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19280 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19281 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19282 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19283 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019284 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019285 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019286 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019288res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19289 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019290 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019291 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019292 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019293 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019295res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19296 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19297 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19298 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019299 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19300 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019303
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019304res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19305rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19306 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19307 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19308 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19309 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19310 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19311 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19312 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314wait_end : boolean
19315 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19316 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019317 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019318 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19319 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019320 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019321 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19322 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019324 Examples :
19325 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19326 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19327 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019329 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19330 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19331 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19332 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19333 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19334 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19335 tcp-request content reject
19336
19337
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193387.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339--------------------------------------
19340
19341It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19342This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19343data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19344its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19345HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19346content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19347to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19348more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19349response are indexed.
19350
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019351Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19352 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19353 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19354 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19355 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19356 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19357 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019359base : string
19360 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19361 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19362 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19363 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19364 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19365 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19366 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19367 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19368
19369 ACL derivatives :
19370 base : exact string match
19371 base_beg : prefix match
19372 base_dir : subdir match
19373 base_dom : domain match
19374 base_end : suffix match
19375 base_len : length match
19376 base_reg : regex match
19377 base_sub : substring match
19378
19379base32 : integer
19380 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19381 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19382 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019383 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19384 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19385 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019386
19387base32+src : binary
19388 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19389 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19390 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19391 per-URL counters.
19392
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019393baseq : string
19394 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19395 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19396 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19397 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19398
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019399capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19400 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19401 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19402 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19403
19404capture.req.method : string
19405 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19406 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19407 because it's allocated.
19408
19409capture.req.uri : string
19410 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19411 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19412 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19413 allocated.
19414
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019415capture.req.ver : string
19416 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19417 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19418 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19419
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019420capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19421 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19422 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19423 The first entry is an index of 0.
19424 See also: "capture response header"
19425
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019426capture.res.ver : string
19427 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19428 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19429 persistent flag.
19430
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019431req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019432 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19433 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19434 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019435
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019436req.body_param([<name>) : string
19437 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19438 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19439 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19440 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19441 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19442 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19443 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19444 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19445 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19446 given.
19447
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019448req.body_len : integer
19449 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19450 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019451 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19452 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019453
19454req.body_size : integer
19455 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019456 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19457 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459req.cook([<name>]) : string
19460cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19461 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19462 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19463 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19464 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19465 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19466 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19467 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19468 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19469
19470 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019471 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19472 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19473 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19474 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19475 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19476 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19477 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19478 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019480req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19481cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19482 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19483 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19486cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19487 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19488 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19489 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19490 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19493 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19494 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19495 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19496 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019497 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019498 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19499 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19500 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19501 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19504 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19505 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19506 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19507 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019508 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019511 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19512 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19513 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19514 with headers such as User-Agent.
19515
19516 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19517 found.
19518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19520 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19521 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019522 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019524req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19525 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19526 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019527 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19528 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19532 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19533 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19534 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19535 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19536 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19537 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19538
19539 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19540 found.
19541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19543 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19544 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019545 with -1 being the last one.
19546
19547 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19548 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550 ACL derivatives :
19551 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19552 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19553 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19554 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19555 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19556 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19557 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19558 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19559
19560req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19561hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19562 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19563 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019564 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19565 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19566 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19567
19568 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19569 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19570 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19571
19572 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019573
19574req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19575hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19576 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19577 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19578 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019579 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19580 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19581 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19582 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19583 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019584
19585 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19586
19587 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019588
19589req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19590hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19591 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19592 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19593 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019594
19595 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19596
19597 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019598
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019599req.hdrs : string
19600 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19601 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19602 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19603 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19604
19605req.hdrs_bin : binary
19606 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19607 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19608 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19609 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19610 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19611 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19612
19613 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019614
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019615 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19616 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19619 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19620 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19621 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19622 basic auth is supported.
19623
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019624http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19625 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19626 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19627 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19628 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019629 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19630 basic auth is supported.
19631
19632 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019633 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19634 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19635 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19636 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019637
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019638http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019639 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19640 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19641 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019642
19643http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019644 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19645 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19646 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019647
19648http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019649 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19650 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19651 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019654 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19655 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19657 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019659method : integer + string
19660 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19661 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19662 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19663 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19664 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19665 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19666 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668 ACL derivatives :
19669 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671 Example :
19672 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19673 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19674 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019676path : string
19677 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19678 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19679 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19680 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19681 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019682 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019683 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685 ACL derivatives :
19686 path : exact string match
19687 path_beg : prefix match
19688 path_dir : subdir match
19689 path_dom : domain match
19690 path_end : suffix match
19691 path_len : length match
19692 path_reg : regex match
19693 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019694
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019695pathq : string
19696 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19697 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19698 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19699 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19700 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19701 result in both cases.
19702
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019703query : string
19704 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19705 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19706 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19707 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019708 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019709 which stops before the question mark.
19710
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019711req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19712 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19713 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19714 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19715 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717req.ver : string
19718req_ver : string (deprecated)
19719 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19720 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19721 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019723 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019724 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019725
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019726res.body : binary
19727 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19728 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019729 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19730
19731 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019732
19733res.body_len : integer
19734 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19735 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019736 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19737
19738 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019739
19740res.body_size : integer
19741 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19742 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19743 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19744 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019745 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19746
19747 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019748
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019749res.cache_hit : boolean
19750 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19751 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19752
19753res.cache_name : string
19754 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19755 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19756 empty string.
19757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019758res.comp : boolean
19759 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19760 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19761 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763res.comp_algo : string
19764 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19765 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19766 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019768res.cook([<name>]) : string
19769scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19770 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19771 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019772 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19773
19774 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019776 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019777 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19780scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19781 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19782 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019783 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19784
19785 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019787res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19788scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19789 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19790 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019791 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19792
19793 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019795res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019796 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19797 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19798
19799 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19800 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19801
19802 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19803
19804 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019806res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019807 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19808 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19809
19810 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19811 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19812
19813 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19816shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019817 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19818 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19819
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019820 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019821 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19822
19823 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019825 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019826 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19827 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19828 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19829 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19830 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19831 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19832 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19833 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019834
19835res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19836shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019837 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19838 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19839
19840 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019841 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019842
19843 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19846shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019847 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19848 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19849
19850 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19851
19852 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019853
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019854res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19855 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19856 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19857 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019858 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19859
19860 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019862res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19863shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019864 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19865 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19866
19867 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19868
19869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019870
19871res.hdrs : string
19872 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19873 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19874 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019875 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19876
19877 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019878
19879res.hdrs_bin : binary
19880 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19881 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19882 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19883 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19884 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19885 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19886 (length of 0 for both).
19887
19888 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19889
19890 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19891 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893res.ver : string
19894resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19895 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019896 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19897
19898 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019900 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019901 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019903set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19904 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19905 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019906 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019907 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019909 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19910 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019912status : integer
19913 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19914 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019915 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19916
19917 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019918
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019919unique-id : string
19920 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19921 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19922 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19923 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19924 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19925 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019927url : string
19928 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19929 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19930 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19931 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19932 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19933 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19934 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019936 ACL derivatives :
19937 url : exact string match
19938 url_beg : prefix match
19939 url_dir : subdir match
19940 url_dom : domain match
19941 url_end : suffix match
19942 url_len : length match
19943 url_reg : regex match
19944 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019946url_ip : ip
19947 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19948 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19949 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19950 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19951 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19952 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19953 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019955url_port : integer
19956 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19957 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19958 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19959 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019960
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019961urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19962url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019963 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19964 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019965 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19966 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19967 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19968 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019969 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19970 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019971 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19972 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019974 ACL derivatives :
19975 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19976 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19977 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19978 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19979 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19980 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19981 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19982 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019983
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985 Example :
19986 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19987 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19988 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19989 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019990
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019991urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019992 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19993 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19994 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019995
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019996url32 : integer
19997 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19998 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19999 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20000 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20001 is an unsigned integer.
20002
20003url32+src : binary
20004 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20005 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20006 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20007
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020008
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200097.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020010---------------------------------------
20011
20012This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20013used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20014purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20015There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20016or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20017any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20018for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20019
20020internal.htx.data : integer
20021 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20022 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20023
20024internal.htx.free : integer
20025 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20026 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20027
20028internal.htx.free_data : integer
20029 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20030 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20031
20032internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020033 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20034 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20035 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020036
20037internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20038 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20039 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20040
20041internal.htx.size : integer
20042 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20043 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20044
20045internal.htx.used : integer
20046 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20047 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20048 direction.
20049
20050internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20051 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20052 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20053 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20054 of the special value :
20055 * head : The oldest inserted block
20056 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020057 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020058
20059internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20060 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20061 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20062 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20063 integer or one of the special value :
20064 * head : The oldest inserted block
20065 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020066 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020067
20068internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20069 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20070 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20071 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20072 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20073
20074 * head : The oldest inserted block
20075 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020076 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020077
20078internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20079 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20080 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20081 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20082 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20083
20084 * head : The oldest inserted block
20085 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020086 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020087
20088internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20089 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20090 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20091 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20092 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20093
20094 * head : The oldest inserted block
20095 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020096 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020097
20098internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20099 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20100 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20101 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20102 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20103
20104 * head : The oldest inserted block
20105 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020106 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020107
20108internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20109 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20110 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20111 it returns false.
20112
20113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201147.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020115---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020117Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20118every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020119order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020121ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020122---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20123FALSE always_false never match
20124HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20125HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20126HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020127HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020128HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20129HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20130HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20131HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20132LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20133METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20134METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20135METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20136METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20137METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20138METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20139METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20140METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20141RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20142REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20143TRUE always_true always match
20144WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20145---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020146
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201488. Logging
20149----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020150
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020151One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20152provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20153very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20154provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20155state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020156to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020157headers.
20158
20159In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20160about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20161send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20162
20163 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20164 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20165 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20166 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20167 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020168 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020169 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020170
20171The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20172allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20173as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20174while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20175real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20176delay.
20177
20178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201798.1. Log levels
20180---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020181
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020182TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020183source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020184HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20185in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20186track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20187syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20188about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020189
20190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201918.2. Log formats
20192----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020194HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020195and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20196slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20197options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198
20199 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20200 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20201 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20202 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20203 extents.
20204
20205 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20206 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20207 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20208 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20209 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20210
20211 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20212 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20213 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20214 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20215 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20216
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020217 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20218 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20219 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20220 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20221
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020222 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20223
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020224Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20225specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20226field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20227servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20228always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20229identifier.
20230
20231Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20232 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20233 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20234 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20235 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20236
20237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202388.2.1. Default log format
20239-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020240
20241This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20242as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20243format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20244
20245 Example :
20246 listen www
20247 mode http
20248 log global
20249 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20250
20251 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20252 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20253 (www/HTTP)
20254
20255 Field Format Extract from the example above
20256 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20257 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20258 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20259 4 'to' to
20260 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20261 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20262
20263Detailed fields description :
20264 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20265 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20266 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20267 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20268 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20269 and processed the connection.
20270 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20271
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020272In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20273"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20274connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20275
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020276It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20277will eventually disappear.
20278
20279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202808.2.2. TCP log format
20281---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020282
20283The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20284is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20285information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20286counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20287emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20288environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20289the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20290sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020291specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20292not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20293fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20294marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020295
20296 Example :
20297 frontend fnt
20298 mode tcp
20299 option tcplog
20300 log global
20301 default_backend bck
20302
20303 backend bck
20304 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20305
20306 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20307 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20308 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20309
20310 Field Format Extract from the example above
20311 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20312 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20313 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20314 4 frontend_name fnt
20315 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20316 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20317 7 bytes_read* 212
20318 8 termination_state --
20319 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20320 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20321
20322Detailed fields description :
20323 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020324 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020325 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20326 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020327 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020328 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020329 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020330
20331 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020332 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20333 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20334 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020336 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020337 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20338 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020339 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20340 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20341 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20342 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343
20344 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20345 and processed the connection.
20346
20347 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20348 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20349 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20350 applications.
20351
20352 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20353 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20354 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20355 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20356 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20357
20358 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20359 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20360 See "Timers" below for more details.
20361
20362 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20363 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20364 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20365 "Timers" below for more details.
20366
20367 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020368 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020369 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20370 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20371 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20372 details.
20373
20374 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20375 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20376 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20377 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20378 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20379
20380 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20381 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20382 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20383 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20384 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20385 for more details.
20386
20387 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020388 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20390 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20391 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020392 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020393
20394 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20395 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20396 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20397 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20398 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20399 caused by a denial of service attack.
20400
20401 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20402 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20403 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20404 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20405 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20406 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20407 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20408 denial of service attack.
20409
20410 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20411 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20412 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20413 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20414 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20415 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20416 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20417 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20418 be processed than on other servers.
20419
20420 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20421 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20422 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20423 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020424 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020425 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20426 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20427 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20428 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20429 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20430 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20431 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20432 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20433
20434 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20435 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20436 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20437 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20438 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20439 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020440 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020441 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20442
20443 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20444 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20445 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20446 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20447 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20448 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020449 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020450 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20451 occurs.
20452
20453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204548.2.3. HTTP log format
20455----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020456
20457The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20458is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20459the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20460are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20461emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20462generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20463"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20464which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020465frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20466is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020467
20468Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20469slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20470with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20471
20472 Example :
20473 frontend http-in
20474 mode http
20475 option httplog
20476 log global
20477 default_backend bck
20478
20479 backend static
20480 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20481
20482 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20483 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20484 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020485 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020486
20487 Field Format Extract from the example above
20488 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20489 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020490 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020491 4 frontend_name http-in
20492 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020493 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020494 7 status_code 200
20495 8 bytes_read* 2750
20496 9 captured_request_cookie -
20497 10 captured_response_cookie -
20498 11 termination_state ----
20499 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20500 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20501 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20502 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20503 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020504
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020505Detailed fields description :
20506 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020507 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020508 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20509 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020510 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020511 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020512 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513
20514 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020515 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20516 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20517 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020518
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020519 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020520 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020521
20522 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20523 and processed the connection.
20524
20525 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20526 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20527 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20528
20529 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20530 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20531 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20532 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20533 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20534 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20535
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020536 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20537 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20538 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020539 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020540 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20541 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020542 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020543 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020544
20545 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20546 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020547 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548
20549 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20550 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020551 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20552 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020553
20554 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20555 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20556 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20557 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20558 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020559 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20560 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020561
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020562 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020563 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20564 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20565 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20566 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20567 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20568 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020569 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020570
20571 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020572 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20573 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
20575 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20576 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020577 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020578 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20579 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20580 overflowing.
20581
20582 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20583 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20584 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20585 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20586 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20587 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20588 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20589 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20590
20591 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20592 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20593 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20594 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20595 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20596 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20597 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20598 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20599
20600 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20601 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20602 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20603 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20604 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20605 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20606 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20607
20608 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020609 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020610 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20611 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20612 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020613 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020614 system.
20615
20616 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20617 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20618 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20619 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20620 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20621 caused by a denial of service attack.
20622
20623 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20624 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20625 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20626 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20627 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20628 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20629 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20630 denial of service attack.
20631
20632 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20633 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20634 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20635 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20636 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20637 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20638 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20639 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20640 processed than on other servers.
20641
20642 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20643 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20644 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20645 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020646 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020647 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20648 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20649 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20650 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20651 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20652 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20653 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20654 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20655
20656 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20657 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20658 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20659 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20660 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20661 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020662 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020663 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20664
20665 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20666 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20667 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20668 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20669 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20670 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020671 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020672 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20673 occurs.
20674
20675 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20676 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20677 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20678 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20679 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20680 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20681 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20682 cookies" below for more details.
20683
20684 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20685 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20686 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20687 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20688 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20689 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20690 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20691 and cookies" below for more details.
20692
20693 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20694 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20695 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20696 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20697 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20698 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20699 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20700 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20701
20702
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207038.2.4. Custom log format
20704------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020705
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020706The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020707mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020708
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020709HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020710Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20711separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20712prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20713
20714Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20715variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020716("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020717
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020718If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020719as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020720less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20721the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20722
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020723Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20724"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20725delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20726preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020727
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020728Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20729'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20730https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20731such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020733Flags are :
20734 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020735 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020736 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20737 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020738
20739 Example:
20740
20741 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20742 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20743
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020744 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20745
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020746At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020748 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20749 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020750
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020751the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020753 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20754 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20755 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020756
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020757and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20758
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020759 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20760 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020761
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020762Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20763
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020765 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020766 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20767 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20768 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020769 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20770 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20771 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020772 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020773 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020774 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020775 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020776 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020777 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20778 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020779 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020780 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020781 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020782 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020783 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020784 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020785 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020786 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20787 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20788 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20789 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20790 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020791 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020792 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020793 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020794 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020795 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020796 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20797 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020798 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20799 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20800 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020801 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020802 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20803 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020804 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020805 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20806 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20807 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020808 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020809 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020810 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20811 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20812 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20813 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020814 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020815 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020816 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020817 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020818 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020819 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020820 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20821 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20822 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020823 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020824 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20825 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020826 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020827 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20828 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020829 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020830 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020831 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020832 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020833
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020834 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020835
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020836
208378.2.5. Error log format
20838-----------------------
20839
20840When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020841protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020842By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20843"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020844will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020845logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20846
20847The format looks like this :
20848
20849 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20850 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20851 Connection error during SSL handshake
20852
20853 Field Format Extract from the example above
20854 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20855 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20856 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20857 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20858 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20859
20860These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20861failures.
20862
20863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208648.3. Advanced logging options
20865-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020866
20867Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20868just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20869options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20870for more information about their usage.
20871
20872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20874------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020875
20876It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020877HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020878commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20879monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20880ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20881
20882 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20883 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20884 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20885 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20886
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020887 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20888 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020889
20890 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20891 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20892 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20893
20894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20896----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020897
20898The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20899what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20900or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020901"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20903log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20904after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20905is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20906with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20907with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20908
20909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209108.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20911------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020912
20913Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20914for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20915"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20916retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20917raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20918a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20919file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20920you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20921"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20922
20923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209248.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20925--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020926
20927Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20928multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20929them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20930"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20931logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20932error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20933and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20934too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20935useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20936alternative.
20937
20938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209398.4. Timing events
20940------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020941
20942Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20943reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20944the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20945frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020946mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20947addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20948
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020949Timings events in HTTP mode:
20950
20951 first request 2nd request
20952 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20953 t tr t tr ...
20954 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20955 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20956 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20957 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020958 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020959 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20960
20961Timings events in TCP mode:
20962
20963 TCP session
20964 |<----------------->|
20965 t t
20966 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20967 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20968 |<------ Tt ------->|
20969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020970 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020971 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020972 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20973 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20974 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020975 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020976 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20977 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20978 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20979 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020981 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20982 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20983 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020984 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20985 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20986 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20987 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20988 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20989 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020990
20991 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20992 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20993 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20994 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20995 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20996 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20997 request typed by hand during a test.
20998
20999 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21000 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021001 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021002 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21003 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21004 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21005 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021006
21007 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21008 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21009 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21010 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21011 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21012
21013 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21014 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21015 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21016 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21017 connection never established.
21018
21019 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21020 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21021 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21022 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21023 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21024 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21025 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21026 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21027 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21028 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21029 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21030
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021031 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21032 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21033 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21034 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21035 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21036 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21037
21038 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21039
21040 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21041 "Ta" can never be negative.
21042
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021043 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21044 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21046 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021047 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021049 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021050
21051 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021052 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21053 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021054
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021055 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21056 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21057 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21058 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21059 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21060 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21061 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21062 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021064These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21065protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21066that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021067due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21068"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21069that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
21071Most common cases :
21072
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021073 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21074 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21075 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21076 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21077 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021078 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021079 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21080 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21081 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21082 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21083 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021084 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021085
21086 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21087 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21088 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21089 of ms on remote networks.
21090
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021091 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21092 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21093 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021094
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021095 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21096 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021097 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021098 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21099 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21100 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21101 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21102 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21103 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021104
21105Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021107 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021108 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021109 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021111 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021112 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21113 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021115 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021116 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21117 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21118 flags.
21119
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021120 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21121 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021122 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21123 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21124 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21125 the client connection was maintained open.
21126
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021127 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021128 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021129 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21131
21132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211338.5. Session state at disconnection
21134-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021135
21136TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21137"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211382-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21139each of which has a special meaning :
21140
21141 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21142 session to terminate :
21143
21144 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21145
21146 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21147 server explicitly refused it.
21148
21149 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21150 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21151 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21152 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021153 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021155 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021156 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021157
21158 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21159 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21160 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21161 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21162 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21163
21164 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21165 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21166 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21167 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21168 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021170 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021171 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21172
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021173 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021174 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21175 backup connections when going up.
21176
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021177 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21180 send or receive data.
21181
21182 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21183 send or receive data.
21184
21185 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21186 with nothing left in the buffers.
21187
21188 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21189
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021190 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021191 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21192
21193 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21194 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21195 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21196 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21197 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21198
21199 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21200 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21201
21202 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21203 server (HTTP only).
21204
21205 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21206
21207 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21208 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21209 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21210
21211 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21212 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21213 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21214
21215 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21216
21217 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21218 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21219
21220 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21221 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21222 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21223
21224 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21225 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021226 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21227 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021228
21229 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21230 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21231 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21232 another server.
21233
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021234 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021235 server.
21236
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021237 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21238 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21239 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21240 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21241
21242 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21243 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21244 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21245 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21246
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021247 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21248 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21249 "use-server" rule).
21250
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021251 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21252
21253 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21254 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21255
21256 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21257
21258 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21259 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21260 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21261
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021262 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21263 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021264 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021265 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21266 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21267
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021268 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21269
21270 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21271 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21272
21273 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21274
21275 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21276
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021277The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21278was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21280starvation, attacks, etc...
21281
21282The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21283alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21284easier finding and understanding.
21285
21286 Flags Reason
21287
21288 -- Normal termination.
21289
21290 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021291 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21292 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021293 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21294
21295 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21296 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021297 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21298 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21300 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021301
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021302 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21303 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021304 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021305
21306 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21307 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21308 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21309
21310 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21311 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21312 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21313 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21314 the server takes too long to respond.
21315
21316 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21317 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21318 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21319 long a time to respond.
21320
21321 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21322 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21323 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021324 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021325 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21326 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327
21328 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21329 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21330 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21331 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21332 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021333 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021334 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21335 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21336 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21337 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21338 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21339 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21340 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21341 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021342 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021343 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21344 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21345 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021346
21347 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21348 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021349 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21350 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21351 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21352 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021353
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021354 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021355 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021357 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021358 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21359 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021360 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021361 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21362 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21363
21364 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21365 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21366 503 or 504 here.
21367
21368 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021369 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021370 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21371 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21372 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21373
21374 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21375 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021376 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021378 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021379
21380 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21381 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21382 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21383 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21384 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21385 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021386 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021387
21388 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21389 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21390 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21391 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21392 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21393 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21394 solution is to fix the application.
21395
21396 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21397 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21398 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21399 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21400 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21401 external attacks.
21402
21403 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021404 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021405 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021406 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21407 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21408
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021409 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21410 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21411 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021412 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021413 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021414
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021415 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21416 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21417 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21418 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021419 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21420 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21421 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21422 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021423 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21424 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21425 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21426 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021427
21428 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21429 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21430 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021431 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21432 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21433 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21434 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435
21436 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21437 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21438 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21439 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21440
21441 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21442 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21443 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21444 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21445
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021446The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021447persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021448important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21449re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21450
21451 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21452
21453 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21454 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21455 set on a GET request.
21456
21457 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21458 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021459 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021460 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21461
21462 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21463 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21464 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21465
21466 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21467 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21468 already got a cookie.
21469
21470 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21471 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21472 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21473 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21474 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21475
21476 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21477 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21478 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21479
21480 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21481 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21482 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21483
21484 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21485 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21486
21487 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21488 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21489 then advertised in the response.
21490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214928.6. Non-printable characters
21493-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021494
21495In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21496consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21497converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21498prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21499being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21500escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21501is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21502'}' when logging headers.
21503
21504Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21505issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21506containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21507
21508Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21509the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21510performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21511
21512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21514---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021515
21516Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21517achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021518section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021519cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21520the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21521the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021522locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021523not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21524user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21525a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21526wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21527
21528 Examples :
21529 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21530 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21531
21532 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21533 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21534
21535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215368.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21537---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021538
21539Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21540proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21541the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21542server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21543
21544Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21545response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021546section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021547
21548It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021549time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21550appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021551are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21552and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21553follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21554request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21555in the logs.
21556
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021557As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21558frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21559an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561 Example :
21562 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21563 listen proxy-out
21564 mode http
21565 option httplog
21566 option logasap
21567 log global
21568 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21569
21570 # log the name of the virtual server
21571 capture request header Host len 20
21572
21573 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21574 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21575
21576 # log the beginning of the referrer
21577 capture request header Referer len 20
21578
21579 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21580 capture response header Server len 20
21581
21582 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21583 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021585 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021586 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21587
21588 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21589 capture response header Via len 20
21590
21591 # log the URL location during a redirection
21592 capture response header Location len 20
21593
21594 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21595 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21596 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21597 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21598 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21599
21600 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21601 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21602 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21603 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021604 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021605
21606 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21607 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21608 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21609 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21610 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021611 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021612
21613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216148.9. Examples of logs
21615---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021616
21617These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21618them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21619reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21620
21621 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21622 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21623 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21624
21625 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21626 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21627
21628 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21629 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21630 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21631
21632 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21633 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21634
21635 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21636 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21637 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21638
21639 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021640 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021641 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21642 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21643
21644 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21645 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21646 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21647
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021648 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21649 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21650 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21651 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021652 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021653 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021654
21655 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021656 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021657
21658 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21659 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21660 Nothing was sent to any server.
21661
21662 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21663 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21664
21665 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21666 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021667 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021668 send a 408 return code to the client.
21669
21670 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21671 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21672
21673 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21674 5 seconds ("c----").
21675
21676 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21677 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021678 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021679
21680 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021681 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021682 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21683 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21684 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21685 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21686 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021687
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021688
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216899. Supported filters
21690--------------------
21691
21692Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21693accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21694unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21695
21696See also : "filter"
21697
216989.1. Trace
21699----------
21700
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021701filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021702
21703 Arguments:
21704 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21705 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21706
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021707 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021708
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021709 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021710 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21711 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21712 amount of the parsed data.
21713
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021714 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021715
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021716This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21717callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21718information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21719filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21720
21721Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21722tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21723a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21724
21725
217269.2. HTTP compression
21727---------------------
21728
21729filter compression
21730
21731The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21732keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021733when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21734fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21735done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21736explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21737filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21738listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21739order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021740
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021741See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21742 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021743
21744
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217459.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21746--------------------------------------------
21747
21748filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21749
21750 Arguments :
21751
21752 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21753 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21754 parsed.
21755
21756 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21757 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21758 part must be placed in its own scope.
21759
21760The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21761external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021762streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021763exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21764also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21765
21766SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21767the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21768
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021769For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021770"doc/SPOE.txt".
21771
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217729.4. Cache
21773----------
21774
21775filter cache <name>
21776
21777 Arguments :
21778
21779 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21780
21781The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21782"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021783cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021784other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21785case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21786is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21787filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021788listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21789order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021790
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021791See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21792 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21793
21794
217959.5. Fcgi-app
21796-------------
21797
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021798filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021799
21800 Arguments :
21801
21802 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21803
21804The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21805request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21806reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21807used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21808implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21809used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21810fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21811used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21812order.
21813
21814See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21815 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21816
21817
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218189.6. OpenTracing
21819----------------
21820
21821The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21822HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21823of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21824Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21825
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021826This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021827
21828The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21829HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21830participates in the work of HAProxy.
21831
21832filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21833
21834 Arguments :
21835
21836 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21837 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21838 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21839 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21840 OpenTracing filters.
21841
21842 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21843 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21844 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21845 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21846 filter must have its own scope defined.
21847
21848More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021849of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021850
21851
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002185210. FastCGI applications
21853-------------------------
21854
21855HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21856feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21857the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21858FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21859servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21860FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21861backend.
21862
21863HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21864application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21865connection.
21866
2186710.1. Setup
21868-----------
21869
2187010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21871--------------------------
21872
21873fcgi-app <name>
21874 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21875 document root must be defined.
21876
21877acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21878 Declare or complete an access list.
21879
21880 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21881 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21882 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21883 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21884 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21885
21886docroot <path>
21887 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21888 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21889 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21890
21891index <script-name>
21892 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21893 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21894 is an optional setting.
21895
21896 Example :
21897 index index.php
21898
21899log-stderr global
21900log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021901 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021902 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21903
21904 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21905 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21906
21907pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21908 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21909 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21910 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21911
21912 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21913 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21914 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21915 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21916
21917 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21918 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21919
21920path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021921 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021922 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21923 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21924 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21925 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21926 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21927 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21928 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021929
21930 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021931 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021932 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21933 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21934 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21935 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021936
21937 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021938 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21939 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021940
21941option get-values
21942no option get-values
21943 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21944
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021945 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021946 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21947
21948 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21949 application will accept.
21950
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021951 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21952 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021953
21954 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021955 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021956 option is disabled.
21957
21958 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21959 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21960 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21961 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21962 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21963 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21964
21965option keep-conn
21966no option keep-conn
21967 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21968 sending a response.
21969
21970 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21971 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21972
21973option max-reqs <reqs>
21974 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21975 accept.
21976
21977 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21978 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21979 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21980 to 1.
21981
21982option mpxs-conns
21983no option mpxs-conns
21984 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21985
21986 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21987 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21988
21989set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21990 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21991 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21992 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21993 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21994
21995 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21996 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21997 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21998
21999 Example :
22000 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22001 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22002
22003 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22004
22005
2200610.1.2. Proxy section
22007---------------------
22008
22009use-fcgi-app <name>
22010 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22011
22012 Arguments :
22013 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22014
22015 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22016 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22017 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22018 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22019 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22020
22021 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22022 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22023 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22024 application are evaluated.
22025
22026
2202710.1.3. Example
22028---------------
22029
22030 frontend front-http
22031 mode http
22032 bind *:80
22033 bind *:
22034
22035 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22036 default_backend back-static
22037
22038 backend back-static
22039 mode http
22040 server www A.B.C.D:80
22041
22042 backend back-dynamic
22043 mode http
22044 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22045 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22046
22047 fcgi-app php-fpm
22048 log-stderr global
22049 option keep-conn
22050
22051 docroot /var/www/my-app
22052 index index.php
22053 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22054
22055
2205610.2. Default parameters
22057------------------------
22058
22059A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22060the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022061script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022062applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22063
22064 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22065 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22066 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22067 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22068 | | |
22069 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22070 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22071 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22072 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22073 | | application. |
22074 | | |
22075 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22076 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22077 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22078 | | |
22079 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22080 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22081 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22082 | | the application's configuration. |
22083 | | |
22084 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22085 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22086 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22087 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22088 | | |
22089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22090 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22091 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22092 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22093 | | be defined. |
22094 | | |
22095 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22096 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22097 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22098 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22099 | | is not set too. |
22100 | | |
22101 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22102 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22103 | | set. |
22104 | | |
22105 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22106 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22107 | | the request. |
22108 | | |
22109 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22110 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22111 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22112 | | |
22113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22114 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22115 | | script to process the request. |
22116 | | |
22117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22118 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22119 | | |
22120 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22121 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22122 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22123 | | |
22124 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22125 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22126 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22127 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22128 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22129 | | |
22130 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22131 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22132 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22133 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22134 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22135 | | side. |
22136 | | |
22137 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22138 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22139 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22140 | | connected to. |
22141 | | |
22142 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22143 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22144 | | |
22145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022146 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22147 | | current HAProxy version. |
22148 | | |
22149 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022150 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22151 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22152 | | |
22153 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22154
22155
2215610.3. Limitations
22157------------------
22158
22159The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22160way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22161during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22162establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22163application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22164or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22165message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22166these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22167and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22168
22169Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22170request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22171requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22172
22173About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22174into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22175fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22176"http-request" ones.
22177
22178Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22179FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22180processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22181must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22182here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022183
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022184
2218511. Address formats
22186-------------------
22187
22188Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22189address.
22190
22191This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22192The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22193of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22194equivalent is '::'.
22195
22196Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22197is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22198
22199This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22200family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22201
22202Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22203configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22204use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22205'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22206
22207Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22208socket type and the transport method.
22209
22210
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002221111.1. Address family prefixes
22212-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022213
22214'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22215
22216'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22217 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22218 listening.
22219
22220'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22221 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22222 on the statement using this address, a port or
22223 a port range may or must be specified.
22224
22225'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22226 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22227 using this address, a port or a port range
22228 may or must be specified.
22229
22230'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22231 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22232 using this address, a port or a port range
22233 may or must be specified.
22234
22235'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22236 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22237 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22238 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22239 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22240 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22241
22242'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22243 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22244 start by slash '/'.
22245
22246
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002224711.2. Socket type prefixes
22248--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022249
22250Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22251type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22252this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22253This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22254but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22255
22256Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022257instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022258
22259If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22260they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22261report this to the maintainers.
22262
22263'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22264 to "stream"
22265
22266'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22267 to "datagram".
22268
22269
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002227011.3. Protocol prefixes
22271-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022272
22273'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22274 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22275 socket type and transport method is forced to
22276 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22277 this address, a port or a port range can or
22278 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22279 of 'stream+ip@'.
22280
22281'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22282 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22283 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22284 statement using this address, a port or port
22285 range can or must be specified.
22286 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22287
22288'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22289 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22290 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22291 statement using this address, a port or port
22292 range can or must be specified.
22293 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22294
22295'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22296 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22297 socket type and transport method is forced to
22298 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22299 this address, a port or a port range can or
22300 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22301 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22302
22303'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22304 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22305 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22306 the statement using this address, a port or
22307 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022308 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022309
22310'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22311 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22312 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22313 the statement using this address, a port or
22314 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022315 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022316
22317'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22318 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22319 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22320
22321'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22322 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22323 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22324
22325In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22326QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022328/*
22329 * Local variables:
22330 * fill-column: 79
22331 * End:
22332 */